]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/dwarf2out.c
re PR debug/12389 ([testcase needed] ICE in gen_subprogram_die for nested function)
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7
8 This file is part of GCC.
9
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
23 02111-1307, USA. */
24
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
36
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "flags.h"
43 #include "real.h"
44 #include "rtl.h"
45 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
46 #include "regs.h"
47 #include "insn-config.h"
48 #include "reload.h"
49 #include "function.h"
50 #include "output.h"
51 #include "expr.h"
52 #include "libfuncs.h"
53 #include "except.h"
54 #include "dwarf2.h"
55 #include "dwarf2out.h"
56 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
57 #include "toplev.h"
58 #include "varray.h"
59 #include "ggc.h"
60 #include "md5.h"
61 #include "tm_p.h"
62 #include "diagnostic.h"
63 #include "debug.h"
64 #include "target.h"
65 #include "langhooks.h"
66 #include "hashtab.h"
67 #include "cgraph.h"
68
69 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
70 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
71 #endif
72
73 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
74 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
75 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
76 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
77 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
78 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
79 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
80 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
81 CIE = Common Information Entry
82 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
83 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
84 FDE = Frame Description Entry
85 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
86 how to restore registers
87
88 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
89 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
90
91 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
92 translation unit. */
93
94 int
95 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
96 {
97 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
98 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
99 #ifdef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
100 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
101 #endif
102 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
103 || flag_unwind_tables
104 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
105 #endif
106 );
107 }
108
109 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
110 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
111 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
112 #endif
113
114 /* Various versions of targetm.eh_frame_section. Note these must appear
115 outside the DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO macro guards. */
116
117 /* Version of targetm.eh_frame_section for systems with named sections. */
118 void
119 named_section_eh_frame_section (void)
120 {
121 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
122 #ifdef HAVE_LD_RO_RW_SECTION_MIXING
123 int fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
124 int per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
125 int lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
126 int flags;
127
128 flags = (! flag_pic
129 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
130 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
131 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
132 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
133 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
134 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
135 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE;
136 named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags);
137 #else
138 named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, SECTION_WRITE);
139 #endif
140 #endif
141 }
142
143 /* Version of targetm.eh_frame_section for systems using collect2. */
144 void
145 collect2_eh_frame_section (void)
146 {
147 tree label = get_file_function_name ('F');
148
149 data_section ();
150 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
151 (*targetm.asm_out.globalize_label) (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
152 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
153 }
154
155 /* Default version of targetm.eh_frame_section. */
156 void
157 default_eh_frame_section (void)
158 {
159 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
160 named_section_eh_frame_section ();
161 #else
162 collect2_eh_frame_section ();
163 #endif
164 }
165
166 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
167 must be kept around forever. */
168 static GTY(()) varray_type used_rtx_varray;
169
170 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
171 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a VARRAY
172 because we want to tell the garbage collector about it. */
173 static GTY(()) varray_type incomplete_types;
174
175 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
176 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
177 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
178 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
179 define type declaration DIE's. */
180 static GTY(()) varray_type decl_scope_table;
181
182 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
183 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
184 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
185 #endif
186
187 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
188 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
189 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
190
191 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
192 Information instructions. The register number, offset
193 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
194 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
195
196 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
197 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
198 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
199 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
200 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
201 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
202 };
203
204 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
205 {
206 unsigned long GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
207 long int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
208 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
209 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
210 }
211 dw_cfi_oprnd;
212
213 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
214 {
215 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
216 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
217 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
218 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
219 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
220 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
221 }
222 dw_cfi_node;
223
224 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
225 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
226 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
227 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
228 of this structure. */
229 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
230 {
231 unsigned long reg;
232 long offset;
233 long base_offset;
234 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
235 } dw_cfa_location;
236
237 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
238 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
239 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
240 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
241 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
242
243 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
244 {
245 const char *dw_fde_begin;
246 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
247 const char *dw_fde_end;
248 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
249 unsigned funcdef_number;
250 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
251 unsigned nothrow : 1;
252 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
253 }
254 dw_fde_node;
255
256 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
257 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
258
259 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
260 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
261 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
262 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
263 pointers. */
264 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
265 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
266 #endif
267
268 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
269 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
270 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
271 as PTR_SIZE. */
272
273 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
274 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
275 #endif
276
277 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
278 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
279 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
280 bytes.
281
282 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
283 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
284
285 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
286 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
287 #endif
288
289 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
290
291 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
292 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
293 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
294
295 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
296 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
297 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
298 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
299 #else
300 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
301 #endif
302 #endif
303
304 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
305 information for each routine. */
306 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
307
308 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
309 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
310
311 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
312 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
313
314 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
315 fde_table. */
316 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
317
318 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
319 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
320
321 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
322 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
323 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
324 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
325 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
326 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
327 #endif
328
329 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
330 {
331 const char *str;
332 unsigned int refcount;
333 unsigned int form;
334 char *label;
335 };
336
337 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
338
339 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
340 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
341
342 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
343
344 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
345
346 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
347 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
348 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
349 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
350 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
351 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
352 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
353 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, long);
354 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
355 static long stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
356 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
357 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
358 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx);
359 static void queue_reg_save (const char *, rtx, long);
360 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
361 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
362 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
363
364 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
365 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
366 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
367 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
368 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
369 (dw_cfa_location *);
370 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
371
372 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
373 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
374 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
375 #endif
376
377 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
378 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
379 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
380
381 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
382 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
383 #endif
384
385 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
386 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
387 #endif
388
389 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
390 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
391 #endif
392
393 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
394 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
395 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
396 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
397 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
398 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
399 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
400 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
401 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
402 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
403 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
404
405 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
406 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
407 registers. */
408 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
409 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
410 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
411 #else
412 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
413 #endif
414 #endif
415
416 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
417 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
418 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
419 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
420 #endif
421
422 /* The offset from the incoming value of %sp to the top of the stack frame
423 for the current function. */
424 #ifndef INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
425 #define INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 0
426 #endif
427 \f
428 /* Hook used by __throw. */
429
430 rtx
431 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
432 {
433 return GEN_INT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
434 }
435
436 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
437 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
438
439 static inline char *
440 stripattributes (const char *s)
441 {
442 char *stripped = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 2);
443 char *p = stripped;
444
445 *p++ = '*';
446
447 while (*s && *s != ',')
448 *p++ = *s++;
449
450 *p = '\0';
451 return stripped;
452 }
453
454 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
455
456 void
457 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
458 {
459 int i;
460 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
461 rtx addr = expand_expr (address, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
462 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
463 bool wrote_return_column = false;
464
465 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
466 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
467 {
468 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
469 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
470 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
471
472 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
473 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
474 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
475 {
476 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
477 continue;
478 wrote_return_column = true;
479 }
480 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
481 if (offset < 0)
482 continue;
483
484 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
485 }
486
487 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
488 if (! wrote_return_column)
489 abort ();
490 i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
491 wrote_return_column = false;
492 #else
493 i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
494 #endif
495
496 if (! wrote_return_column)
497 {
498 enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
499 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
500 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
501 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
502 }
503 }
504
505 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
506
507 static const char *
508 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
509 {
510 switch (cfi_opc)
511 {
512 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
513 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
514 case DW_CFA_offset:
515 return "DW_CFA_offset";
516 case DW_CFA_restore:
517 return "DW_CFA_restore";
518 case DW_CFA_nop:
519 return "DW_CFA_nop";
520 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
521 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
523 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
524 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
525 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
526 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
527 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
528 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
529 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
530 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
531 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
532 case DW_CFA_undefined:
533 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
534 case DW_CFA_same_value:
535 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
536 case DW_CFA_register:
537 return "DW_CFA_register";
538 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
539 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
540 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
541 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
542 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
543 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
544 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
545 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
546 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
547 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
548
549 /* DWARF 3 */
550 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
551 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
552 case DW_CFA_expression:
553 return "DW_CFA_expression";
554 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
555 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
556 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
557 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
558 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
559 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
560
561 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
562 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
563 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
564
565 /* GNU extensions */
566 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
567 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
568 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
569 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
570 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
571 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
572
573 default:
574 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
575 }
576 }
577
578 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
579
580 static inline dw_cfi_ref
581 new_cfi (void)
582 {
583 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
584
585 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
586 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
587 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
588
589 return cfi;
590 }
591
592 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
593
594 static inline void
595 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
596 {
597 dw_cfi_ref *p;
598
599 /* Find the end of the chain. */
600 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
601 ;
602
603 *p = cfi;
604 }
605
606 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
607
608 char *
609 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
610 {
611 static char label[20];
612
613 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
614 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
615 return label;
616 }
617
618 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
619 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
620
621 static void
622 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
623 {
624 if (label)
625 {
626 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
627
628 if (*label == 0)
629 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
630
631 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
632 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
633 {
634 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
635
636 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
637
638 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
639 xcfi = new_cfi ();
640 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
641 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
642 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
643 }
644
645 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
646 }
647
648 else
649 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
650 }
651
652 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
653
654 static inline void
655 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
656 {
657 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
658 {
659 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
660 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
661 break;
662 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
663 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
664 break;
665 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
666 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
667 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
668 break;
669 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
670 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
671 break;
672 default:
673 break;
674 }
675 }
676
677 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
678
679 static void
680 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
681 {
682 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
683
684 loc->reg = (unsigned long) -1;
685 loc->offset = 0;
686 loc->indirect = 0;
687 loc->base_offset = 0;
688
689 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
690 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
691
692 if (fde_table_in_use)
693 {
694 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
695 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
696 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
697 }
698 }
699
700 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
701 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
702
703 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
704 from the CFA. */
705 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
706
707 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
708 static long args_size;
709
710 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
711 static long old_args_size;
712
713 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
714 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
715 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
716
717 void
718 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, long int offset)
719 {
720 dw_cfa_location loc;
721 loc.indirect = 0;
722 loc.base_offset = 0;
723 loc.reg = reg;
724 loc.offset = offset;
725 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
726 }
727
728 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
729 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
730
731 static void
732 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
733 {
734 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
735 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
736
737 cfa = *loc_p;
738 loc = *loc_p;
739
740 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
741 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
742
743 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
744 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
745
746 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
747 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
748 && loc.indirect == old_cfa.indirect
749 && (loc.indirect == 0 || loc.base_offset == old_cfa.base_offset))
750 return;
751
752 cfi = new_cfi ();
753
754 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
755 {
756 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction,
757 indicating the CFA register did not change but the offset
758 did. */
759 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
760 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
761 }
762
763 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
764 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset && old_cfa.reg != (unsigned long) -1
765 && !loc.indirect)
766 {
767 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
768 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
769 offset has not changed. */
770 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
771 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
772 }
773 #endif
774
775 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
776 {
777 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
778 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
779 the specified offset. */
780 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
781 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
782 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
783 }
784 else
785 {
786 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
787 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
788 register-offset pair is available. */
789 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
790
791 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
792 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc);
793 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
794 }
795
796 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
797 }
798
799 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
800 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
801 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
802 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
803
804 static void
805 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, long int offset)
806 {
807 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
808
809 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
810
811 /* The following comparison is correct. -1 is used to indicate that
812 the value isn't a register number. */
813 if (sreg == (unsigned int) -1)
814 {
815 if (reg & ~0x3f)
816 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
817 the long form. */
818 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
819 else
820 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
821
822 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
823 {
824 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
825 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
826 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
827 description. */
828 long check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
829
830 if (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT != offset)
831 abort ();
832 }
833 #endif
834 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
835 if (offset < 0)
836 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
837
838 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
839 }
840 else if (sreg == reg)
841 /* We could emit a DW_CFA_same_value in this case, but don't bother. */
842 return;
843 else
844 {
845 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
846 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
847 }
848
849 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
850 }
851
852 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
853 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
854 from the previous frame's window save area.
855
856 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
857 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
858
859 void
860 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
861 {
862 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
863
864 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
865 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
866 }
867
868 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
869 pushed onto the stack. */
870
871 void
872 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, long int size)
873 {
874 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
875
876 if (size == old_args_size)
877 return;
878
879 old_args_size = size;
880
881 cfi = new_cfi ();
882 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
883 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
884 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
885 }
886
887 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
888 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
889
890 void
891 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, long int offset)
892 {
893 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), -1, offset);
894 }
895
896 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
897 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
898
899 void
900 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, long int offset)
901 {
902 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, -1, offset);
903 }
904
905 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
906 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
907
908 void
909 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
910 {
911 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, sreg, 0);
912 }
913
914 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
915 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
916
917 static void
918 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
919 {
920 unsigned int reg = (unsigned int) -1;
921 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
922
923 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
924 {
925 case REG:
926 /* RA is in a register. */
927 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
928 break;
929
930 case MEM:
931 /* RA is on the stack. */
932 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
933 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
934 {
935 case REG:
936 if (REGNO (rtl) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
937 abort ();
938 offset = 0;
939 break;
940
941 case PLUS:
942 if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
943 abort ();
944 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
945 break;
946
947 case MINUS:
948 if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
949 abort ();
950 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
951 break;
952
953 default:
954 abort ();
955 }
956
957 break;
958
959 case PLUS:
960 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
961 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
962 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
963 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != CONST_INT)
964 abort ();
965 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
966 return;
967
968 default:
969 abort ();
970 }
971
972 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
973 }
974
975 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
976 contains. */
977
978 static long
979 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
980 {
981 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
982 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
983 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
984 enum rtx_code code;
985
986 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
987 {
988 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
989 code = GET_CODE (src);
990 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
991 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
992 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
993 return 0;
994
995 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
996 if (code == PLUS)
997 offset = -offset;
998 }
999 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
1000 {
1001 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1002 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1003 code = GET_CODE (src);
1004
1005 switch (code)
1006 {
1007 case PRE_MODIFY:
1008 case POST_MODIFY:
1009 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1010 {
1011 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1012 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1013 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != PLUS ||
1014 GET_CODE (val) != CONST_INT)
1015 abort ();
1016 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1017 break;
1018 }
1019 return 0;
1020
1021 case PRE_DEC:
1022 case POST_DEC:
1023 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1024 {
1025 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1026 break;
1027 }
1028 return 0;
1029
1030 case PRE_INC:
1031 case POST_INC:
1032 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1033 {
1034 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1035 break;
1036 }
1037 return 0;
1038
1039 default:
1040 return 0;
1041 }
1042 }
1043 else
1044 return 0;
1045
1046 return offset;
1047 }
1048
1049 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1050 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1051 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1052
1053 static void
1054 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn)
1055 {
1056 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1057 const char *label;
1058 int i;
1059
1060 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
1061 {
1062 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1063 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1064 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1065 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1066 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1067 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1068 if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL)
1069 abort ();
1070
1071 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1072 return;
1073 }
1074
1075 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1076 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1077 else if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1078 return;
1079
1080 if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
1081 {
1082 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1083 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1084 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1085 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1086 offset = -args_size;
1087 #else
1088 offset = args_size;
1089 #endif
1090 }
1091 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1092 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1093 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1094 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1095 {
1096 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1097 for them. */
1098 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1099 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1100 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1101 }
1102 else
1103 return;
1104
1105 if (offset == 0)
1106 return;
1107
1108 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1109 cfa.offset += offset;
1110
1111 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1112 offset = -offset;
1113 #endif
1114
1115 args_size += offset;
1116 if (args_size < 0)
1117 args_size = 0;
1118
1119 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1120 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1121 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1122 }
1123
1124 #endif
1125
1126 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1127 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1128 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1129
1130 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1131 {
1132 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1133 rtx reg;
1134 long cfa_offset;
1135 };
1136
1137 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1138
1139 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1140 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1141
1142 static void
1143 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, long int offset)
1144 {
1145 struct queued_reg_save *q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1146
1147 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1148 q->reg = reg;
1149 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1150 queued_reg_saves = q;
1151
1152 last_reg_save_label = label;
1153 }
1154
1155 static void
1156 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1157 {
1158 struct queued_reg_save *q, *next;
1159
1160 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = next)
1161 {
1162 dwarf2out_reg_save (last_reg_save_label, REGNO (q->reg), q->cfa_offset);
1163 next = q->next;
1164 }
1165
1166 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1167 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1168 }
1169
1170 static bool
1171 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1172 {
1173 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1174
1175 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1176 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1177 return true;
1178
1179 return false;
1180 }
1181
1182
1183 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1184 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1185 value, not an offset. */
1186 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1187
1188 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1189 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1190 address) or saves a register to the stack. LABEL indicates the
1191 address of EXPR.
1192
1193 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1194 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1195 users need not read the source code.
1196
1197 The High-Level Picture
1198
1199 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1200 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1201 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1202 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1203 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1204
1205 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1206 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1207 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1208 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1209 saves. This also seems to work.
1210
1211 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1212 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1213 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1214 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1215
1216 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1217 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1218 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1219 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1220
1221 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1222
1223 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1224 consists of a register and an offset.
1225 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1226 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1227 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1228 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1229 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1230 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1231 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1232
1233 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1234 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1235 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1236 cfa_temp.offset.
1237
1238 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1239 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1240 and cfa_temp.offset.
1241
1242 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1243 stack.
1244
1245 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1246 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1247 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1248
1249 The Rules
1250
1251 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1252 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1253
1254 Rule 1:
1255 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1256 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1257 cfa.offset unchanged
1258 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1259 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1260
1261 Rule 2:
1262 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1263 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1264 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1265 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1266 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1267 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1268
1269 Rule 3:
1270 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1271 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1272 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1273
1274 Rule 4:
1275 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1276 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1277 <reg1> != sp
1278 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1279 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1280 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1281
1282 Rule 5:
1283 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1284 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1285 <reg1> != sp
1286 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1287 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1288
1289 Rule 6:
1290 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1291 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1292 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1293
1294 Rule 7:
1295 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1296 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1297 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1298
1299 Rule 8:
1300 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1301 effects: none
1302
1303 Rule 9:
1304 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1305 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1306 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1307
1308 Rule 10:
1309 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1310 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1311 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1312 cfa.reg = sp
1313 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1314
1315 Rule 11:
1316 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1317 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1318 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1319 cfa.reg = sp
1320 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1321
1322 Rule 12:
1323 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1324
1325 <reg2>)
1326 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1327 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1328
1329 Rule 13:
1330 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1331 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1332 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1333
1334 Rule 14:
1335 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1336 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1337 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1338 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem) */
1339
1340 static void
1341 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1342 {
1343 rtx src, dest;
1344 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1345
1346 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1347 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1348 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1349 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1350 flag is set in them. */
1351 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1352 {
1353 int par_index;
1354 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1355
1356 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1357 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1358 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1359 || par_index == 0))
1360 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1361
1362 return;
1363 }
1364
1365 if (GET_CODE (expr) != SET)
1366 abort ();
1367
1368 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1369 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1370
1371 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1372 {
1373 case REG:
1374 /* Rule 1 */
1375 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1376 relative to the current CFA register. */
1377 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1378 {
1379 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1380 case REG:
1381 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1382 /* OK. */
1383 ;
1384 else
1385 abort ();
1386
1387 /* We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1388 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1389 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1390 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1391 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1392 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1393 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1394 break;
1395
1396 case PLUS:
1397 case MINUS:
1398 case LO_SUM:
1399 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1400 {
1401 /* Rule 2 */
1402 /* Adjusting SP. */
1403 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1404 {
1405 case CONST_INT:
1406 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1407 break;
1408 case REG:
1409 if ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1)) != cfa_temp.reg)
1410 abort ();
1411 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1412 break;
1413 default:
1414 abort ();
1415 }
1416
1417 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1418 {
1419 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1420 if (cfa.reg != (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
1421 abort ();
1422 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1423 }
1424 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1425 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1426 ;
1427 else if (XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx)
1428 abort ();
1429
1430 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1431 offset = -offset;
1432 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1433 cfa.offset += offset;
1434 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1435 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1436 }
1437 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1438 {
1439 /* Rule 3 */
1440 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1441 or adjusting the FP */
1442 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1443 abort ();
1444
1445 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1446 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1447 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1448 {
1449 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1450 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1451 offset = -offset;
1452 cfa.offset += offset;
1453 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1454 }
1455 else
1456 abort ();
1457 }
1458 else
1459 {
1460 if (GET_CODE (src) == MINUS)
1461 abort ();
1462
1463 /* Rule 4 */
1464 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1465 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1466 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1467 {
1468 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1469 into the FP later on. */
1470 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1471 cfa.offset += offset;
1472 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1473 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1474 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1475 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1476 }
1477
1478 /* Rule 5 */
1479 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1480 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1481 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1482 {
1483 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1484 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1485 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1486 abort ();
1487 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1488 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1489 }
1490
1491 /* Rule 9 */
1492 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1493 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1494 {
1495 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1496 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1497 }
1498 else
1499 abort ();
1500 }
1501 break;
1502
1503 /* Rule 6 */
1504 case CONST_INT:
1505 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1506 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1507 break;
1508
1509 /* Rule 7 */
1510 case IOR:
1511 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) != REG
1512 || (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) != cfa_temp.reg
1513 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1514 abort ();
1515
1516 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1517 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1518 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1519 break;
1520
1521 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1522 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1523 /* Rule 8 */
1524 case HIGH:
1525 break;
1526
1527 default:
1528 abort ();
1529 }
1530
1531 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1532 break;
1533
1534 case MEM:
1535 if (GET_CODE (src) != REG)
1536 abort ();
1537
1538 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1539 CFA register. */
1540 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1541 {
1542 /* Rule 10 */
1543 /* With a push. */
1544 case PRE_MODIFY:
1545 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1546 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1)) != CONST_INT)
1547 abort ();
1548 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1549
1550 if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1551 || cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1552 abort ();
1553
1554 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1555 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1556 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1557
1558 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1559 break;
1560
1561 /* Rule 11 */
1562 case PRE_INC:
1563 case PRE_DEC:
1564 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1565 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1566 offset = -offset;
1567
1568 if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1569 || cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1570 abort ();
1571
1572 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1573 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1574 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1575
1576 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1577 break;
1578
1579 /* Rule 12 */
1580 /* With an offset. */
1581 case PLUS:
1582 case MINUS:
1583 case LO_SUM:
1584 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) != CONST_INT)
1585 abort ();
1586 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1587 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1588 offset = -offset;
1589
1590 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1591 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1592 else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1593 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1594 else
1595 abort ();
1596 break;
1597
1598 /* Rule 13 */
1599 /* Without an offset. */
1600 case REG:
1601 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1602 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1603 else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1604 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1605 else
1606 abort ();
1607 break;
1608
1609 /* Rule 14 */
1610 case POST_INC:
1611 if (cfa_temp.reg != (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1612 abort ();
1613 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1614 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1615 break;
1616
1617 default:
1618 abort ();
1619 }
1620
1621 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1622 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1623 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1624 {
1625 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1626
1627 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1628 {
1629 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1630 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1631 on the ARM. */
1632 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1633 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, offset);
1634 break;
1635 }
1636 else
1637 {
1638 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1639 calculate the CFA. */
1640 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1641
1642 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
1643 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1644 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
1645 abort ();
1646
1647 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1648 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1649 cfa.indirect = 1;
1650 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1651 break;
1652 }
1653 }
1654
1655 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1656 queue_reg_save (label, src, offset);
1657 break;
1658
1659 default:
1660 abort ();
1661 }
1662 }
1663
1664 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1665 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1666 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state. */
1667
1668 void
1669 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn)
1670 {
1671 const char *label;
1672 rtx src;
1673
1674 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1675 {
1676 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1677 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1678
1679 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1680 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1681 if (cfa.reg != (unsigned long) DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM))
1682 abort ();
1683
1684 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1685 cfa_store = cfa;
1686 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1687 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1688 return;
1689 }
1690
1691 if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1692 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1693
1694 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1695 {
1696 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1697 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn);
1698
1699 return;
1700 }
1701
1702 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1703 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1704 if (src)
1705 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1706 else
1707 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1708
1709 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1710 }
1711
1712 #endif
1713
1714 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1715 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1716 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1717
1718 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1719 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1720 {
1721 switch (cfi)
1722 {
1723 case DW_CFA_nop:
1724 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1725 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1726
1727 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1728 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1729 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1730 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1731 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1732 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1733
1734 case DW_CFA_offset:
1735 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1736 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1737 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1738 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1739 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1740 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1741 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1742 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1743 case DW_CFA_register:
1744 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1745
1746 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1747 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1748 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1749 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1750
1751 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1752 case DW_CFA_expression:
1753 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1754
1755 default:
1756 abort ();
1757 }
1758 }
1759
1760 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1761 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1762 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1763
1764 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1765 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1766 {
1767 switch (cfi)
1768 {
1769 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1770 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1771 case DW_CFA_offset:
1772 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1773 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1774 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1775
1776 case DW_CFA_register:
1777 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1778
1779 default:
1780 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1781 }
1782 }
1783
1784 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1785
1786 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
1787
1788 static void
1789 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
1790 {
1791 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
1792 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1793 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
1794 "DW_CFA_advance_loc 0x%lx",
1795 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
1796 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
1797 {
1798 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1799 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
1800 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx",
1801 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
1802 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1803 }
1804 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
1805 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1806 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
1807 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx",
1808 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
1809 else
1810 {
1811 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
1812 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
1813
1814 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
1815 {
1816 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1817 if (for_eh)
1818 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
1819 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
1820 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
1821 NULL);
1822 else
1823 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
1824 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
1825 break;
1826
1827 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1828 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1829 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1830 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1831 break;
1832
1833 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1834 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1835 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1836 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1837 break;
1838
1839 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1840 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1841 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1842 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1843 break;
1844
1845 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1846 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1847 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1848 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1849 break;
1850
1851 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1852 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1853 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1854 NULL);
1855 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1856 break;
1857
1858 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1859 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1860 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1861 NULL);
1862 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1863 break;
1864
1865 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1866 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1867 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1868 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1869 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1870 NULL);
1871 break;
1872
1873 case DW_CFA_register:
1874 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1875 NULL);
1876 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1877 NULL);
1878 break;
1879
1880 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1881 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1882 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1883 break;
1884
1885 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1886 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1887 break;
1888
1889 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1890 break;
1891
1892 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1893 case DW_CFA_expression:
1894 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
1895 break;
1896
1897 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
1898 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
1899 abort ();
1900
1901 default:
1902 break;
1903 }
1904 }
1905 }
1906
1907 /* Output the call frame information used to used to record information
1908 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
1909 location of saved registers. */
1910
1911 static void
1912 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
1913 {
1914 unsigned int i;
1915 dw_fde_ref fde;
1916 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1917 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
1918 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
1919 char augmentation[6];
1920 int augmentation_size;
1921 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1922 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1923 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1924
1925 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
1926 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
1927 return;
1928
1929 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
1930 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
1931 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
1932 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
1933 if (for_eh)
1934 {
1935 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
1936
1937 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
1938 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
1939 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
1940 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
1941 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
1942 any_eh_needed = true;
1943
1944 if (! any_eh_needed)
1945 return;
1946 }
1947
1948 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
1949 if (flag_debug_asm)
1950 app_enable ();
1951
1952 if (for_eh)
1953 (*targetm.asm_out.eh_frame_section) ();
1954 else
1955 named_section_flags (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
1956
1957 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
1958 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
1959
1960 /* Output the CIE. */
1961 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
1962 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
1963 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
1964 "Length of Common Information Entry");
1965 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
1966
1967 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
1968 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
1969 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
1970 (for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
1971 "CIE Identifier Tag");
1972
1973 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
1974
1975 augmentation[0] = 0;
1976 augmentation_size = 0;
1977 if (for_eh)
1978 {
1979 char *p;
1980
1981 /* Augmentation:
1982 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
1983 augmentation section.
1984 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
1985 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
1986 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
1987 FDE code pointers.
1988 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
1989 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
1990
1991 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
1992 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
1993 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1994
1995 p = augmentation + 1;
1996 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
1997 {
1998 *p++ = 'P';
1999 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2000 }
2001 if (any_lsda_needed)
2002 {
2003 *p++ = 'L';
2004 augmentation_size += 1;
2005 }
2006 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2007 {
2008 *p++ = 'R';
2009 augmentation_size += 1;
2010 }
2011 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2012 {
2013 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2014 *p = '\0';
2015 }
2016
2017 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2018 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2019 {
2020 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2021 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2022 + 1 /* CIE version */
2023 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2024 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2025 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2026 + 1 /* RA column */
2027 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2028 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2029 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2030
2031 augmentation_size += pad;
2032
2033 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2034 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2035 if (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) != 1)
2036 abort ();
2037 }
2038 }
2039
2040 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2041 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2042 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2043 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2044 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, "CIE RA Column");
2045
2046 if (augmentation[0])
2047 {
2048 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2049 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2050 {
2051 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2052 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2053 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2054 eh_personality_libfunc, NULL);
2055 }
2056
2057 if (any_lsda_needed)
2058 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2059 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2060
2061 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2062 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2063 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2064 }
2065
2066 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2067 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2068
2069 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2070 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2071 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2072 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2073
2074 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2075 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2076 {
2077 fde = &fde_table[i];
2078
2079 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2080 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2081 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2082 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2083 continue;
2084
2085 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2086 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2087 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2088 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2089 "FDE Length");
2090 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2091
2092 if (for_eh)
2093 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2094 else
2095 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2096 "FDE CIE offset");
2097
2098 if (for_eh)
2099 {
2100 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2101 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin),
2102 "FDE initial location");
2103 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2104 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2105 "FDE address range");
2106 }
2107 else
2108 {
2109 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2110 "FDE initial location");
2111 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2112 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2113 "FDE address range");
2114 }
2115
2116 if (augmentation[0])
2117 {
2118 if (any_lsda_needed)
2119 {
2120 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2121
2122 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2123 {
2124 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2125 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2126 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2127 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2128 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2129
2130 size += pad;
2131 if (size_of_uleb128 (size) != 1)
2132 abort ();
2133 }
2134
2135 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2136
2137 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2138 {
2139 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2140 fde->funcdef_number);
2141 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2142 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2143 "Language Specific Data Area");
2144 }
2145 else
2146 {
2147 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2148 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2149 dw2_asm_output_data
2150 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2151 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2152 }
2153 }
2154 else
2155 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2156 }
2157
2158 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2159 this FDE. */
2160 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2161 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2162 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2163
2164 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2165 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2166 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2167 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2168 }
2169
2170 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2171 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2172 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2173 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2174 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2175 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2176 #endif
2177
2178 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2179 if (flag_debug_asm)
2180 app_disable ();
2181 }
2182
2183 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2184 the prologue. */
2185
2186 void
2187 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2188 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2189 {
2190 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2191 dw_fde_ref fde;
2192
2193 current_function_func_begin_label = 0;
2194
2195 #ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
2196 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2197 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2198 be used. */
2199 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2200 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2201 return;
2202 #else
2203 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2204 return;
2205 #endif
2206
2207 function_section (current_function_decl);
2208 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2209 current_function_funcdef_no);
2210 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2211 current_function_funcdef_no);
2212 current_function_func_begin_label = get_identifier (label);
2213
2214 #ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
2215 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2216 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2217 return;
2218 #endif
2219
2220 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2221 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2222 {
2223 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2224 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2225 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2226 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2227 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2228 }
2229
2230 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2231 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2232
2233 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2234 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2235 fde->dw_fde_begin = xstrdup (label);
2236 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2237 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2238 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2239 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2240 fde->nothrow = current_function_nothrow;
2241 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2242 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2243
2244 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2245
2246 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2247 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2248 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2249 if (file)
2250 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2251 #endif
2252 }
2253
2254 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2255 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2256 been generated. */
2257
2258 void
2259 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2260 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2261 {
2262 dw_fde_ref fde;
2263 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2264
2265 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2266 function. */
2267 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2268 current_function_funcdef_no);
2269 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2270 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2271 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2272 }
2273
2274 void
2275 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2276 {
2277 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2278 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2279 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2280 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2281
2282 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2283 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2284
2285 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2286 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2287 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2288 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2289 #endif
2290 }
2291
2292 void
2293 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2294 {
2295 /* Output call frame information. */
2296 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
2297 output_call_frame_info (0);
2298
2299 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2300 output_call_frame_info (1);
2301 }
2302 #endif
2303 \f
2304 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2305 for emitting location expressions. */
2306
2307 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2308 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2309 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2310
2311
2312 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2313 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2314 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2315 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2316
2317 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2318 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2319 implementation are listed below. */
2320
2321 enum dw_val_class
2322 {
2323 dw_val_class_addr,
2324 dw_val_class_offset,
2325 dw_val_class_loc,
2326 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2327 dw_val_class_range_list,
2328 dw_val_class_const,
2329 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2330 dw_val_class_long_long,
2331 dw_val_class_float,
2332 dw_val_class_flag,
2333 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2334 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2335 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2336 dw_val_class_lbl_offset,
2337 dw_val_class_str
2338 };
2339
2340 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2341 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2342
2343 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2344 {
2345 unsigned long hi;
2346 unsigned long low;
2347 }
2348 dw_long_long_const;
2349
2350 /* Describe a floating point constant value. */
2351
2352 typedef struct dw_fp_struct GTY(())
2353 {
2354 long * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2355 unsigned length;
2356 }
2357 dw_float_const;
2358
2359 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2360 represented internally. */
2361
2362 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2363 {
2364 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2365 union dw_val_struct_union
2366 {
2367 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2368 long unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2369 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2370 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2371 long int GTY ((default (""))) val_int;
2372 long unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2373 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2374 dw_float_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_float"))) val_float;
2375 struct dw_val_die_union
2376 {
2377 dw_die_ref die;
2378 int external;
2379 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2380 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2381 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2382 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2383 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2384 }
2385 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2386 }
2387 dw_val_node;
2388
2389 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2390 operations. */
2391
2392 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2393 {
2394 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2395 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2396 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2397 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2398 int dw_loc_addr;
2399 }
2400 dw_loc_descr_node;
2401
2402 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2403 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2404 their entire life. */
2405 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2406 {
2407 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2408 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2409 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2410 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2411 Only on head of list */
2412 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2413 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2414 } dw_loc_list_node;
2415
2416 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2417
2418 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2419 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2420 unsigned long, unsigned long);
2421 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2422 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2423 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2424 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2425 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2426
2427 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2428
2429 static const char *
2430 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2431 {
2432 switch (op)
2433 {
2434 case DW_OP_addr:
2435 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2436 return "DW_OP_addr";
2437 case DW_OP_deref:
2438 return "DW_OP_deref";
2439 case DW_OP_const1u:
2440 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2441 case DW_OP_const1s:
2442 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2443 case DW_OP_const2u:
2444 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2445 case DW_OP_const2s:
2446 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2447 case DW_OP_const4u:
2448 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2449 case DW_OP_const4s:
2450 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2451 case DW_OP_const8u:
2452 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2453 case DW_OP_const8s:
2454 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2455 case DW_OP_constu:
2456 return "DW_OP_constu";
2457 case DW_OP_consts:
2458 return "DW_OP_consts";
2459 case DW_OP_dup:
2460 return "DW_OP_dup";
2461 case DW_OP_drop:
2462 return "DW_OP_drop";
2463 case DW_OP_over:
2464 return "DW_OP_over";
2465 case DW_OP_pick:
2466 return "DW_OP_pick";
2467 case DW_OP_swap:
2468 return "DW_OP_swap";
2469 case DW_OP_rot:
2470 return "DW_OP_rot";
2471 case DW_OP_xderef:
2472 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2473 case DW_OP_abs:
2474 return "DW_OP_abs";
2475 case DW_OP_and:
2476 return "DW_OP_and";
2477 case DW_OP_div:
2478 return "DW_OP_div";
2479 case DW_OP_minus:
2480 return "DW_OP_minus";
2481 case DW_OP_mod:
2482 return "DW_OP_mod";
2483 case DW_OP_mul:
2484 return "DW_OP_mul";
2485 case DW_OP_neg:
2486 return "DW_OP_neg";
2487 case DW_OP_not:
2488 return "DW_OP_not";
2489 case DW_OP_or:
2490 return "DW_OP_or";
2491 case DW_OP_plus:
2492 return "DW_OP_plus";
2493 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2494 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2495 case DW_OP_shl:
2496 return "DW_OP_shl";
2497 case DW_OP_shr:
2498 return "DW_OP_shr";
2499 case DW_OP_shra:
2500 return "DW_OP_shra";
2501 case DW_OP_xor:
2502 return "DW_OP_xor";
2503 case DW_OP_bra:
2504 return "DW_OP_bra";
2505 case DW_OP_eq:
2506 return "DW_OP_eq";
2507 case DW_OP_ge:
2508 return "DW_OP_ge";
2509 case DW_OP_gt:
2510 return "DW_OP_gt";
2511 case DW_OP_le:
2512 return "DW_OP_le";
2513 case DW_OP_lt:
2514 return "DW_OP_lt";
2515 case DW_OP_ne:
2516 return "DW_OP_ne";
2517 case DW_OP_skip:
2518 return "DW_OP_skip";
2519 case DW_OP_lit0:
2520 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2521 case DW_OP_lit1:
2522 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2523 case DW_OP_lit2:
2524 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2525 case DW_OP_lit3:
2526 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2527 case DW_OP_lit4:
2528 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2529 case DW_OP_lit5:
2530 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2531 case DW_OP_lit6:
2532 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2533 case DW_OP_lit7:
2534 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2535 case DW_OP_lit8:
2536 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2537 case DW_OP_lit9:
2538 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2539 case DW_OP_lit10:
2540 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2541 case DW_OP_lit11:
2542 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2543 case DW_OP_lit12:
2544 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2545 case DW_OP_lit13:
2546 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2547 case DW_OP_lit14:
2548 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2549 case DW_OP_lit15:
2550 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2551 case DW_OP_lit16:
2552 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2553 case DW_OP_lit17:
2554 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2555 case DW_OP_lit18:
2556 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2557 case DW_OP_lit19:
2558 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2559 case DW_OP_lit20:
2560 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2561 case DW_OP_lit21:
2562 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2563 case DW_OP_lit22:
2564 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2565 case DW_OP_lit23:
2566 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2567 case DW_OP_lit24:
2568 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2569 case DW_OP_lit25:
2570 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2571 case DW_OP_lit26:
2572 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2573 case DW_OP_lit27:
2574 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2575 case DW_OP_lit28:
2576 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2577 case DW_OP_lit29:
2578 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2579 case DW_OP_lit30:
2580 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2581 case DW_OP_lit31:
2582 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2583 case DW_OP_reg0:
2584 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2585 case DW_OP_reg1:
2586 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2587 case DW_OP_reg2:
2588 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2589 case DW_OP_reg3:
2590 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2591 case DW_OP_reg4:
2592 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2593 case DW_OP_reg5:
2594 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2595 case DW_OP_reg6:
2596 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2597 case DW_OP_reg7:
2598 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2599 case DW_OP_reg8:
2600 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2601 case DW_OP_reg9:
2602 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2603 case DW_OP_reg10:
2604 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2605 case DW_OP_reg11:
2606 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2607 case DW_OP_reg12:
2608 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2609 case DW_OP_reg13:
2610 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2611 case DW_OP_reg14:
2612 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2613 case DW_OP_reg15:
2614 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2615 case DW_OP_reg16:
2616 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2617 case DW_OP_reg17:
2618 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2619 case DW_OP_reg18:
2620 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2621 case DW_OP_reg19:
2622 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2623 case DW_OP_reg20:
2624 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2625 case DW_OP_reg21:
2626 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2627 case DW_OP_reg22:
2628 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2629 case DW_OP_reg23:
2630 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2631 case DW_OP_reg24:
2632 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2633 case DW_OP_reg25:
2634 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2635 case DW_OP_reg26:
2636 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2637 case DW_OP_reg27:
2638 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2639 case DW_OP_reg28:
2640 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2641 case DW_OP_reg29:
2642 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2643 case DW_OP_reg30:
2644 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2645 case DW_OP_reg31:
2646 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2647 case DW_OP_breg0:
2648 return "DW_OP_breg0";
2649 case DW_OP_breg1:
2650 return "DW_OP_breg1";
2651 case DW_OP_breg2:
2652 return "DW_OP_breg2";
2653 case DW_OP_breg3:
2654 return "DW_OP_breg3";
2655 case DW_OP_breg4:
2656 return "DW_OP_breg4";
2657 case DW_OP_breg5:
2658 return "DW_OP_breg5";
2659 case DW_OP_breg6:
2660 return "DW_OP_breg6";
2661 case DW_OP_breg7:
2662 return "DW_OP_breg7";
2663 case DW_OP_breg8:
2664 return "DW_OP_breg8";
2665 case DW_OP_breg9:
2666 return "DW_OP_breg9";
2667 case DW_OP_breg10:
2668 return "DW_OP_breg10";
2669 case DW_OP_breg11:
2670 return "DW_OP_breg11";
2671 case DW_OP_breg12:
2672 return "DW_OP_breg12";
2673 case DW_OP_breg13:
2674 return "DW_OP_breg13";
2675 case DW_OP_breg14:
2676 return "DW_OP_breg14";
2677 case DW_OP_breg15:
2678 return "DW_OP_breg15";
2679 case DW_OP_breg16:
2680 return "DW_OP_breg16";
2681 case DW_OP_breg17:
2682 return "DW_OP_breg17";
2683 case DW_OP_breg18:
2684 return "DW_OP_breg18";
2685 case DW_OP_breg19:
2686 return "DW_OP_breg19";
2687 case DW_OP_breg20:
2688 return "DW_OP_breg20";
2689 case DW_OP_breg21:
2690 return "DW_OP_breg21";
2691 case DW_OP_breg22:
2692 return "DW_OP_breg22";
2693 case DW_OP_breg23:
2694 return "DW_OP_breg23";
2695 case DW_OP_breg24:
2696 return "DW_OP_breg24";
2697 case DW_OP_breg25:
2698 return "DW_OP_breg25";
2699 case DW_OP_breg26:
2700 return "DW_OP_breg26";
2701 case DW_OP_breg27:
2702 return "DW_OP_breg27";
2703 case DW_OP_breg28:
2704 return "DW_OP_breg28";
2705 case DW_OP_breg29:
2706 return "DW_OP_breg29";
2707 case DW_OP_breg30:
2708 return "DW_OP_breg30";
2709 case DW_OP_breg31:
2710 return "DW_OP_breg31";
2711 case DW_OP_regx:
2712 return "DW_OP_regx";
2713 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2714 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
2715 case DW_OP_bregx:
2716 return "DW_OP_bregx";
2717 case DW_OP_piece:
2718 return "DW_OP_piece";
2719 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2720 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
2721 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2722 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
2723 case DW_OP_nop:
2724 return "DW_OP_nop";
2725 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
2726 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
2727 case DW_OP_call2:
2728 return "DW_OP_call2";
2729 case DW_OP_call4:
2730 return "DW_OP_call4";
2731 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2732 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
2733 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
2734 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
2735 default:
2736 return "OP_<unknown>";
2737 }
2738 }
2739
2740 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
2741 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
2742 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
2743
2744 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
2745 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, long unsigned int oprnd1,
2746 long unsigned int oprnd2)
2747 {
2748 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
2749
2750 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
2751 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2752 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
2753 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2754 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
2755
2756 return descr;
2757 }
2758
2759
2760 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
2761
2762 static inline void
2763 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
2764 {
2765 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
2766
2767 /* Find the end of the chain. */
2768 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
2769 ;
2770
2771 *d = descr;
2772 }
2773
2774 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
2775
2776 static unsigned long
2777 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2778 {
2779 unsigned long size = 1;
2780
2781 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2782 {
2783 case DW_OP_addr:
2784 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2785 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
2786 break;
2787 case DW_OP_const1u:
2788 case DW_OP_const1s:
2789 size += 1;
2790 break;
2791 case DW_OP_const2u:
2792 case DW_OP_const2s:
2793 size += 2;
2794 break;
2795 case DW_OP_const4u:
2796 case DW_OP_const4s:
2797 size += 4;
2798 break;
2799 case DW_OP_const8u:
2800 case DW_OP_const8s:
2801 size += 8;
2802 break;
2803 case DW_OP_constu:
2804 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2805 break;
2806 case DW_OP_consts:
2807 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2808 break;
2809 case DW_OP_pick:
2810 size += 1;
2811 break;
2812 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2813 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2814 break;
2815 case DW_OP_skip:
2816 case DW_OP_bra:
2817 size += 2;
2818 break;
2819 case DW_OP_breg0:
2820 case DW_OP_breg1:
2821 case DW_OP_breg2:
2822 case DW_OP_breg3:
2823 case DW_OP_breg4:
2824 case DW_OP_breg5:
2825 case DW_OP_breg6:
2826 case DW_OP_breg7:
2827 case DW_OP_breg8:
2828 case DW_OP_breg9:
2829 case DW_OP_breg10:
2830 case DW_OP_breg11:
2831 case DW_OP_breg12:
2832 case DW_OP_breg13:
2833 case DW_OP_breg14:
2834 case DW_OP_breg15:
2835 case DW_OP_breg16:
2836 case DW_OP_breg17:
2837 case DW_OP_breg18:
2838 case DW_OP_breg19:
2839 case DW_OP_breg20:
2840 case DW_OP_breg21:
2841 case DW_OP_breg22:
2842 case DW_OP_breg23:
2843 case DW_OP_breg24:
2844 case DW_OP_breg25:
2845 case DW_OP_breg26:
2846 case DW_OP_breg27:
2847 case DW_OP_breg28:
2848 case DW_OP_breg29:
2849 case DW_OP_breg30:
2850 case DW_OP_breg31:
2851 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2852 break;
2853 case DW_OP_regx:
2854 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2855 break;
2856 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2857 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2858 break;
2859 case DW_OP_bregx:
2860 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2861 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
2862 break;
2863 case DW_OP_piece:
2864 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2865 break;
2866 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2867 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2868 size += 1;
2869 break;
2870 case DW_OP_call2:
2871 size += 2;
2872 break;
2873 case DW_OP_call4:
2874 size += 4;
2875 break;
2876 case DW_OP_call_ref:
2877 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
2878 break;
2879 default:
2880 break;
2881 }
2882
2883 return size;
2884 }
2885
2886 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
2887
2888 static unsigned long
2889 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2890 {
2891 unsigned long size;
2892
2893 for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2894 {
2895 loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
2896 size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
2897 }
2898
2899 return size;
2900 }
2901
2902 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
2903
2904 static void
2905 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2906 {
2907 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2908 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2909
2910 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2911 {
2912 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2913 case DW_OP_addr:
2914 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2915 break;
2916 case DW_OP_const2u:
2917 case DW_OP_const2s:
2918 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2919 break;
2920 case DW_OP_const4u:
2921 case DW_OP_const4s:
2922 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2923 break;
2924 case DW_OP_const8u:
2925 case DW_OP_const8s:
2926 if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG < 64)
2927 abort ();
2928 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2929 break;
2930 case DW_OP_skip:
2931 case DW_OP_bra:
2932 {
2933 int offset;
2934
2935 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
2936 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2937 else
2938 abort ();
2939
2940 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2941 }
2942 break;
2943 #else
2944 case DW_OP_addr:
2945 case DW_OP_const2u:
2946 case DW_OP_const2s:
2947 case DW_OP_const4u:
2948 case DW_OP_const4s:
2949 case DW_OP_const8u:
2950 case DW_OP_const8s:
2951 case DW_OP_skip:
2952 case DW_OP_bra:
2953 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2954 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2955 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2956 only doing unwinding. */
2957 abort ();
2958 #endif
2959 case DW_OP_const1u:
2960 case DW_OP_const1s:
2961 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2962 break;
2963 case DW_OP_constu:
2964 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2965 break;
2966 case DW_OP_consts:
2967 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2968 break;
2969 case DW_OP_pick:
2970 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2971 break;
2972 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2973 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2974 break;
2975 case DW_OP_breg0:
2976 case DW_OP_breg1:
2977 case DW_OP_breg2:
2978 case DW_OP_breg3:
2979 case DW_OP_breg4:
2980 case DW_OP_breg5:
2981 case DW_OP_breg6:
2982 case DW_OP_breg7:
2983 case DW_OP_breg8:
2984 case DW_OP_breg9:
2985 case DW_OP_breg10:
2986 case DW_OP_breg11:
2987 case DW_OP_breg12:
2988 case DW_OP_breg13:
2989 case DW_OP_breg14:
2990 case DW_OP_breg15:
2991 case DW_OP_breg16:
2992 case DW_OP_breg17:
2993 case DW_OP_breg18:
2994 case DW_OP_breg19:
2995 case DW_OP_breg20:
2996 case DW_OP_breg21:
2997 case DW_OP_breg22:
2998 case DW_OP_breg23:
2999 case DW_OP_breg24:
3000 case DW_OP_breg25:
3001 case DW_OP_breg26:
3002 case DW_OP_breg27:
3003 case DW_OP_breg28:
3004 case DW_OP_breg29:
3005 case DW_OP_breg30:
3006 case DW_OP_breg31:
3007 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3008 break;
3009 case DW_OP_regx:
3010 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3011 break;
3012 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3013 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3014 break;
3015 case DW_OP_bregx:
3016 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3017 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3018 break;
3019 case DW_OP_piece:
3020 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3021 break;
3022 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3023 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3024 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3025 break;
3026
3027 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3028 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
3029 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (asm_out_file, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3030 val1->v.val_addr);
3031 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3032 #else
3033 abort ();
3034 #endif
3035 break;
3036
3037 default:
3038 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3039 break;
3040 }
3041 }
3042
3043 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3044
3045 static void
3046 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3047 {
3048 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3049 {
3050 /* Output the opcode. */
3051 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3052 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3053
3054 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3055 output_loc_operands (loc);
3056 }
3057 }
3058
3059 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3060 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3061
3062 static void
3063 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3064 {
3065 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3066 unsigned long size;
3067
3068 /* Output the size of the block. */
3069 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3070 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3071 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3072
3073 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3074 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3075 }
3076
3077 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from
3078 a dw_cfa_location. */
3079
3080 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3081 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa)
3082 {
3083 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3084
3085 if (cfa->indirect == 0)
3086 abort ();
3087
3088 if (cfa->base_offset)
3089 {
3090 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3091 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3092 else
3093 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3094 }
3095 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3096 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3097 else
3098 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3099
3100 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3101 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3102 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3103 if (cfa->offset != 0)
3104 {
3105 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, cfa->offset, 0);
3106 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3107 }
3108
3109 return head;
3110 }
3111
3112 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3113 descriptor sequence. */
3114
3115 static void
3116 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3117 {
3118 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3119 cfa->offset = 0;
3120 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3121 cfa->indirect = 0;
3122 cfa->reg = -1;
3123
3124 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3125 {
3126 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3127
3128 switch (op)
3129 {
3130 case DW_OP_reg0:
3131 case DW_OP_reg1:
3132 case DW_OP_reg2:
3133 case DW_OP_reg3:
3134 case DW_OP_reg4:
3135 case DW_OP_reg5:
3136 case DW_OP_reg6:
3137 case DW_OP_reg7:
3138 case DW_OP_reg8:
3139 case DW_OP_reg9:
3140 case DW_OP_reg10:
3141 case DW_OP_reg11:
3142 case DW_OP_reg12:
3143 case DW_OP_reg13:
3144 case DW_OP_reg14:
3145 case DW_OP_reg15:
3146 case DW_OP_reg16:
3147 case DW_OP_reg17:
3148 case DW_OP_reg18:
3149 case DW_OP_reg19:
3150 case DW_OP_reg20:
3151 case DW_OP_reg21:
3152 case DW_OP_reg22:
3153 case DW_OP_reg23:
3154 case DW_OP_reg24:
3155 case DW_OP_reg25:
3156 case DW_OP_reg26:
3157 case DW_OP_reg27:
3158 case DW_OP_reg28:
3159 case DW_OP_reg29:
3160 case DW_OP_reg30:
3161 case DW_OP_reg31:
3162 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3163 break;
3164 case DW_OP_regx:
3165 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3166 break;
3167 case DW_OP_breg0:
3168 case DW_OP_breg1:
3169 case DW_OP_breg2:
3170 case DW_OP_breg3:
3171 case DW_OP_breg4:
3172 case DW_OP_breg5:
3173 case DW_OP_breg6:
3174 case DW_OP_breg7:
3175 case DW_OP_breg8:
3176 case DW_OP_breg9:
3177 case DW_OP_breg10:
3178 case DW_OP_breg11:
3179 case DW_OP_breg12:
3180 case DW_OP_breg13:
3181 case DW_OP_breg14:
3182 case DW_OP_breg15:
3183 case DW_OP_breg16:
3184 case DW_OP_breg17:
3185 case DW_OP_breg18:
3186 case DW_OP_breg19:
3187 case DW_OP_breg20:
3188 case DW_OP_breg21:
3189 case DW_OP_breg22:
3190 case DW_OP_breg23:
3191 case DW_OP_breg24:
3192 case DW_OP_breg25:
3193 case DW_OP_breg26:
3194 case DW_OP_breg27:
3195 case DW_OP_breg28:
3196 case DW_OP_breg29:
3197 case DW_OP_breg30:
3198 case DW_OP_breg31:
3199 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3200 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3201 break;
3202 case DW_OP_bregx:
3203 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3204 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3205 break;
3206 case DW_OP_deref:
3207 cfa->indirect = 1;
3208 break;
3209 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3210 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3211 break;
3212 default:
3213 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented\n",
3214 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3215 }
3216 }
3217 }
3218 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3219 \f
3220 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3221 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3222
3223 /* .debug_str support. */
3224 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3225
3226 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3227 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3228 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3229 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3230 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3231 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3232 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3233 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3234 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3235 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3236 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3237
3238 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3239
3240 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3241 {
3242 dwarf2out_init,
3243 dwarf2out_finish,
3244 dwarf2out_define,
3245 dwarf2out_undef,
3246 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3247 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3248 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3249 dwarf2out_end_block,
3250 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3251 dwarf2out_source_line,
3252 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3253 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3254 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3255 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
3256 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3257 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3258 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3259 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3260 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3261 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3262 something tries to reference them. */
3263 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3264 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3265 debug_nothing_int /* handle_pch */
3266 };
3267 #endif
3268 \f
3269 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3270 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3271 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3272
3273 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3274 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3275 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3276 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3277
3278 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3279 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3280
3281 typedef long int dw_offset;
3282
3283 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3284
3285 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3286 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3287 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3288 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3289 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3290
3291 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3292 line number associated with the label generated for that
3293 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3294 the line number entry. */
3295
3296 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3297 {
3298 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3299 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3300 }
3301 dw_line_info_entry;
3302
3303 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3304 own sequence. */
3305 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3306 {
3307 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3308 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3309 unsigned long function;
3310 }
3311 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3312
3313 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3314 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3315 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3316
3317 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3318 {
3319 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3320 dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
3321 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3322 }
3323 dw_attr_node;
3324
3325 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
3326
3327 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3328 {
3329 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3330 char *die_symbol;
3331 dw_attr_ref die_attr;
3332 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3333 dw_die_ref die_child;
3334 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3335 dw_offset die_offset;
3336 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3337 int die_mark;
3338 }
3339 die_node;
3340
3341 /* The pubname structure */
3342
3343 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3344 {
3345 dw_die_ref die;
3346 char *name;
3347 }
3348 pubname_entry;
3349
3350 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3351 {
3352 int block_num;
3353 };
3354
3355 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3356 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3357 {
3358 dw_die_ref die;
3359 tree created_for;
3360 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3361 }
3362 limbo_die_node;
3363
3364 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3365 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3366 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3367 #endif
3368
3369 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3370 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3371
3372 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3373 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3374 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3375 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3376 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3377 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3378
3379 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3380 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3381 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3382 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3383 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3384 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3385 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3386 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3387 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3388 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3389
3390 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3391 language, and compiler version. */
3392
3393 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3394 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3395 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3396
3397 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3398 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3399
3400 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3401 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3402 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3403 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3404 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3405
3406 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3407 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3408 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3409 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3410 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3411 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3412
3413 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3414 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3415 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3416 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3417 #else
3418 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3419 #endif
3420 #endif
3421
3422 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3423 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3424 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3425
3426 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3427 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3428
3429 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3430 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3431
3432 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3433 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3434 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3435 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3436 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3437
3438 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3439 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3440 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3441 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3442 #endif
3443
3444 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3445 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3446
3447 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3448 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3449
3450 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3451 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table;
3452 static GTY(()) varray_type file_table_emitted;
3453 static GTY(()) size_t file_table_last_lookup_index;
3454
3455 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to DIE's that describe
3456 declarations. The table is indexed by DECL_UID() which is a unique
3457 number identifying each decl. */
3458 static GTY((length ("decl_die_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *decl_die_table;
3459
3460 /* Number of elements currently allocated for the decl_die_table. */
3461 static GTY(()) unsigned decl_die_table_allocated;
3462
3463 /* Number of elements in decl_die_table currently in use. */
3464 static GTY(()) unsigned decl_die_table_in_use;
3465
3466 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3467 decl_die_table. */
3468 #define DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3469
3470 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3471 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3472 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3473 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3474 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3475
3476 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3477 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3478
3479 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3480 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3481
3482 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3483 abbrev_die_table. */
3484 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3485
3486 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3487 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3488 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3489 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3490
3491 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3492 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3493
3494 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3495 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3496
3497 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3498 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3499 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3500 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3501
3502 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3503 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3504
3505 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3506 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3507
3508 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3509 line_info_table. */
3510 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3511
3512 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3513 accessible names. */
3514 static GTY ((length ("pubname_table_allocated"))) pubname_ref pubname_table;
3515
3516 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3517 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3518
3519 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3520 static GTY(()) unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3521
3522 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3523 pubname_table. */
3524 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3525
3526 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3527 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3528
3529 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3530 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3531
3532 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3533 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3534
3535 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3536 arange_table. */
3537 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3538
3539 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3540 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3541
3542 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3543 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3544
3545 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3546 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3547
3548 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3549 ranges_table. */
3550 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3551
3552 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3553 static GTY(()) unsigned have_location_lists;
3554
3555 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3556 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3557 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3558 #endif
3559 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3560 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3561 #endif
3562
3563 /* Number of file tables emitted in maybe_emit_file(). */
3564 static GTY(()) int emitcount = 0;
3565
3566 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3567 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3568
3569 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3570
3571 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3572
3573 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
3574 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3575 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
3576 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3577 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3578 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3579 #if 0
3580 static const char *dwarf_type_encoding_name (unsigned);
3581 #endif
3582 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
3583 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
3584 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3585 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
3586 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
3587 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3588 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
3589 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, long);
3590 static inline long int AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
3591 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long);
3592 static inline unsigned long AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
3593 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
3594 unsigned long);
3595 static void add_AT_float (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned, long *);
3596 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
3597 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
3598 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3599 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
3600 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
3601 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3602 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
3603 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
3604 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
3605 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3606 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3607 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
3608 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3609 dw_loc_list_ref);
3610 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
3611 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
3612 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
3613 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3614 static void add_AT_lbl_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3615 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long);
3616 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3617 unsigned long);
3618 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
3619 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3620 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3621 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3622 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3623 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3624 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3625 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3626 static bool is_c_family (void);
3627 static bool is_cxx (void);
3628 static bool is_java (void);
3629 static bool is_fortran (void);
3630 static bool is_ada (void);
3631 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3632 static inline void free_die (dw_die_ref);
3633 static void remove_children (dw_die_ref);
3634 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3635 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3636 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3637 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3638 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3639 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3640 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3641 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3642 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
3643 static void reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref);
3644 static void reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3645 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3646 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
3647 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3648 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3649 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3650 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3651 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
3652 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
3653 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3654 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3655 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
3656 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3657 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3658 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
3659 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
3660 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
3661 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
3662 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
3663 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
3664 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
3665 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
3666 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3667 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
3668 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3669 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
3670 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3671 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3672 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3673 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3674 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3675 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (void);
3676 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3677 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3678 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
3679 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3680 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
3681 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3682 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
3683 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
3684 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3685 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3686 static void output_pubnames (void);
3687 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
3688 static void output_aranges (void);
3689 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
3690 static void output_ranges (void);
3691 static void output_line_info (void);
3692 static void output_file_names (void);
3693 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
3694 static tree root_type (tree);
3695 static int is_base_type (tree);
3696 static bool is_ada_subrange_type (tree);
3697 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree);
3698 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
3699 static int type_is_enum (tree);
3700 static unsigned int reg_number (rtx);
3701 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
3702 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
3703 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
3704 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
3705 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (unsigned, long);
3706 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
3707 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
3708 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
3709 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
3710 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
3711 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3712 static tree field_type (tree);
3713 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
3714 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
3715 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
3716 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
3717 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3718 dw_loc_descr_ref);
3719 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3720 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3721 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3722 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3723 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3724 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3725 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3726 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
3727 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
3728 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3729 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3730 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3731 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3732 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3733 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3734 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3735 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3736 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3737 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3738 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3739 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3740 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3741 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
3742 static const char *type_tag (tree);
3743 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
3744 #if 0
3745 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3746 #endif
3747 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3748 static void gen_set_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3749 #if 0
3750 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3751 #endif
3752 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3753 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3754 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3755 static void gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3756 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3757 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3758 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3759 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3760 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3761 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3762 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3763 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3764 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3765 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3766 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3767 static void gen_string_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3768 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3769 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3770 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3771 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3772 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3773 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3774 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3775 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3776 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
3777 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
3778 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3779 static unsigned lookup_filename (const char *);
3780 static void init_file_table (void);
3781 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3782 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3783 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3784 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3785 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3786 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
3787 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
3788 const char *, const char *,
3789 const char *);
3790 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3791 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3792
3793 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3794 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3795 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3796 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3797 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3798 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3799 static int maybe_emit_file (int);
3800
3801 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3802 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3803 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3804 #endif
3805 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3806 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3807 #endif
3808 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3809 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3810 #endif
3811 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3812 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3813 #endif
3814 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3815 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3816 #endif
3817 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3818 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3819 #endif
3820 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3821 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
3822 #endif
3823 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3824 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3825 #endif
3826 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3827 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3828 #endif
3829
3830 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3831 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3832 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3833 #endif
3834
3835 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3836 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3837 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
3838 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3839 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3840
3841 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3842 the section names themselves. */
3843
3844 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3845 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3846 #endif
3847 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3848 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3849 #endif
3850 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3851 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3852 #endif
3853 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3854 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3855 #endif
3856 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3857 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3858 #endif
3859 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3860 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3861 #endif
3862 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3863 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3864 #endif
3865
3866 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3867 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3868 options is used and DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3869 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3870 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3871
3872 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3873 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3874 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3875 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3876 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3877 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3878 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3879 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3880
3881 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3882 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3883 #endif
3884 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3885 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3886 #endif
3887 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3888 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3889 #endif
3890 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3891 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3892 #endif
3893 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
3894 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
3895 #endif
3896 \f
3897 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3898 called to "demangle" any name before it it put into a DIE. */
3899
3900 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3901
3902 void
3903 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3904 {
3905 demangle_name_func = func;
3906 }
3907
3908 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3909
3910 static inline int
3911 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
3912 {
3913 return ((GET_CODE (rtl) == REG && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3914 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3915 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3916 }
3917
3918 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3919 removed. */
3920
3921 static inline tree
3922 type_main_variant (tree type)
3923 {
3924 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3925
3926 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3927 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3928 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3929 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3930 here. */
3931 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3932 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3933 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3934
3935 return type;
3936 }
3937
3938 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3939
3940 static inline int
3941 is_tagged_type (tree type)
3942 {
3943 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3944
3945 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3946 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3947 }
3948
3949 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3950
3951 static const char *
3952 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
3953 {
3954 switch (tag)
3955 {
3956 case DW_TAG_padding:
3957 return "DW_TAG_padding";
3958 case DW_TAG_array_type:
3959 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
3960 case DW_TAG_class_type:
3961 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
3962 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
3963 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
3964 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
3965 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
3966 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
3967 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
3968 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
3969 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
3970 case DW_TAG_label:
3971 return "DW_TAG_label";
3972 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
3973 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
3974 case DW_TAG_member:
3975 return "DW_TAG_member";
3976 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
3977 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
3978 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
3979 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
3980 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
3981 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
3982 case DW_TAG_string_type:
3983 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
3984 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
3985 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
3986 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
3987 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
3988 case DW_TAG_typedef:
3989 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
3990 case DW_TAG_union_type:
3991 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
3992 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
3993 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
3994 case DW_TAG_variant:
3995 return "DW_TAG_variant";
3996 case DW_TAG_common_block:
3997 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
3998 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
3999 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4000 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4001 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4002 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4003 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4004 case DW_TAG_module:
4005 return "DW_TAG_module";
4006 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4007 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4008 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4009 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4010 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4011 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4012 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4013 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4014 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4015 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4016 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4017 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4018 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4019 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4020 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4021 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4022 case DW_TAG_constant:
4023 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4024 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4025 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4026 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4027 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4028 case DW_TAG_friend:
4029 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4030 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4031 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4032 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4033 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4034 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4035 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4036 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4037 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4038 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4039 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4040 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4041 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4042 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4043 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4044 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4045 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4046 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4047 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4048 case DW_TAG_variable:
4049 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4050 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4051 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4052 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4053 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4054 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4055 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4056 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4057 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4058 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4059 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4060 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4061 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4062 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4063 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4064 default:
4065 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4066 }
4067 }
4068
4069 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4070
4071 static const char *
4072 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4073 {
4074 switch (attr)
4075 {
4076 case DW_AT_sibling:
4077 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4078 case DW_AT_location:
4079 return "DW_AT_location";
4080 case DW_AT_name:
4081 return "DW_AT_name";
4082 case DW_AT_ordering:
4083 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4084 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4085 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4086 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4087 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4088 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4089 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4090 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4091 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4092 case DW_AT_element_list:
4093 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4094 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4095 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4096 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4097 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4098 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4099 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4100 case DW_AT_language:
4101 return "DW_AT_language";
4102 case DW_AT_member:
4103 return "DW_AT_member";
4104 case DW_AT_discr:
4105 return "DW_AT_discr";
4106 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4107 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4108 case DW_AT_visibility:
4109 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4110 case DW_AT_import:
4111 return "DW_AT_import";
4112 case DW_AT_string_length:
4113 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4114 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4115 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4116 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4117 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4118 case DW_AT_const_value:
4119 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4120 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4121 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4122 case DW_AT_default_value:
4123 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4124 case DW_AT_inline:
4125 return "DW_AT_inline";
4126 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4127 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4128 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4129 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4130 case DW_AT_producer:
4131 return "DW_AT_producer";
4132 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4133 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4134 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4135 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4136 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4137 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4138 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4139 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4140 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4141 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4142 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4143 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4144 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4145 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4146 case DW_AT_address_class:
4147 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4148 case DW_AT_artificial:
4149 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4150 case DW_AT_base_types:
4151 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4152 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4153 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4154 case DW_AT_count:
4155 return "DW_AT_count";
4156 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4157 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4158 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4159 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4160 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4161 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4162 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4163 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4164 case DW_AT_declaration:
4165 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4166 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4167 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4168 case DW_AT_encoding:
4169 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4170 case DW_AT_external:
4171 return "DW_AT_external";
4172 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4173 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4174 case DW_AT_friend:
4175 return "DW_AT_friend";
4176 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4177 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4178 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4179 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4180 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4181 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4182 case DW_AT_priority:
4183 return "DW_AT_priority";
4184 case DW_AT_segment:
4185 return "DW_AT_segment";
4186 case DW_AT_specification:
4187 return "DW_AT_specification";
4188 case DW_AT_static_link:
4189 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4190 case DW_AT_type:
4191 return "DW_AT_type";
4192 case DW_AT_use_location:
4193 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4194 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4195 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4196 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4197 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4198 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4199 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4200
4201 case DW_AT_allocated:
4202 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4203 case DW_AT_associated:
4204 return "DW_AT_associated";
4205 case DW_AT_data_location:
4206 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4207 case DW_AT_stride:
4208 return "DW_AT_stride";
4209 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4210 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4211 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4212 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4213 case DW_AT_extension:
4214 return "DW_AT_extension";
4215 case DW_AT_ranges:
4216 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4217 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4218 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4219 case DW_AT_call_column:
4220 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4221 case DW_AT_call_file:
4222 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4223 case DW_AT_call_line:
4224 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4225
4226 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4227 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4228 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4229 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4230 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4231 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4232 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4233 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4234 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4235 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4236 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4237 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4238 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4239 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4240 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4241 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4242 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4243 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4244 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4245 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4246 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4247 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4248
4249 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4250 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4251 case DW_AT_src_info:
4252 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4253 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4254 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4255 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4256 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4257 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4258 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4259 case DW_AT_body_end:
4260 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4261 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4262 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4263
4264 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4265 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4266
4267 default:
4268 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4269 }
4270 }
4271
4272 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4273
4274 static const char *
4275 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4276 {
4277 switch (form)
4278 {
4279 case DW_FORM_addr:
4280 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4281 case DW_FORM_block2:
4282 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4283 case DW_FORM_block4:
4284 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4285 case DW_FORM_data2:
4286 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4287 case DW_FORM_data4:
4288 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4289 case DW_FORM_data8:
4290 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4291 case DW_FORM_string:
4292 return "DW_FORM_string";
4293 case DW_FORM_block:
4294 return "DW_FORM_block";
4295 case DW_FORM_block1:
4296 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4297 case DW_FORM_data1:
4298 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4299 case DW_FORM_flag:
4300 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4301 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4302 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4303 case DW_FORM_strp:
4304 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4305 case DW_FORM_udata:
4306 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4307 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4308 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4309 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4310 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4311 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4312 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4313 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4314 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4315 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4316 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4317 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4318 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4319 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4320 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4321 default:
4322 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4323 }
4324 }
4325
4326 /* Convert a DWARF type code into its string name. */
4327
4328 #if 0
4329 static const char *
4330 dwarf_type_encoding_name (unsigned enc)
4331 {
4332 switch (enc)
4333 {
4334 case DW_ATE_address:
4335 return "DW_ATE_address";
4336 case DW_ATE_boolean:
4337 return "DW_ATE_boolean";
4338 case DW_ATE_complex_float:
4339 return "DW_ATE_complex_float";
4340 case DW_ATE_float:
4341 return "DW_ATE_float";
4342 case DW_ATE_signed:
4343 return "DW_ATE_signed";
4344 case DW_ATE_signed_char:
4345 return "DW_ATE_signed_char";
4346 case DW_ATE_unsigned:
4347 return "DW_ATE_unsigned";
4348 case DW_ATE_unsigned_char:
4349 return "DW_ATE_unsigned_char";
4350 default:
4351 return "DW_ATE_<unknown>";
4352 }
4353 }
4354 #endif
4355 \f
4356 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4357 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4358 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4359 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4360 given block. */
4361
4362 static tree
4363 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4364 {
4365 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4366 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4367 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4368 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4369 return NULL_TREE;
4370
4371 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
4372 if (DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)))
4373 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4374 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4375 abort ();
4376 #endif
4377
4378 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4379 }
4380
4381 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4382 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4383 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4384 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4385 given block. */
4386
4387 static tree
4388 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4389 {
4390 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4391
4392 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4393 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4394 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4395 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4396 return NULL_TREE;
4397
4398 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4399 return NULL_TREE;
4400 else
4401 {
4402 tree ret_val;
4403 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4404
4405 do
4406 {
4407 ret_val = lookahead;
4408 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4409 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4410 }
4411 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4412
4413 return ret_val;
4414 }
4415 }
4416
4417 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4418 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4419 parameter. */
4420
4421 static tree
4422 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4423 {
4424 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4425
4426 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4427 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4428 else
4429 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4430 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4431
4432 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4433 context = NULL_TREE;
4434
4435 return context;
4436 }
4437 \f
4438 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
4439 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
4440
4441 static inline void
4442 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4443 {
4444 if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
4445 {
4446 attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
4447 die->die_attr = attr;
4448 }
4449 }
4450
4451 static inline enum dw_val_class
4452 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4453 {
4454 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4455 }
4456
4457 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4458
4459 static inline void
4460 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4461 {
4462 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4463
4464 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4465 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4466 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4467 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4468 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4469 }
4470
4471 static inline unsigned
4472 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4473 {
4474 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag)
4475 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4476
4477 abort ();
4478 }
4479
4480 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4481
4482 static inline void
4483 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, long int int_val)
4484 {
4485 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4486
4487 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4488 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4489 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4490 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4491 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4492 }
4493
4494 static inline long int
4495 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4496 {
4497 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const)
4498 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4499
4500 abort ();
4501 }
4502
4503 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4504
4505 static inline void
4506 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4507 long unsigned int unsigned_val)
4508 {
4509 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4510
4511 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4512 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4513 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4514 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4515 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4516 }
4517
4518 static inline unsigned long
4519 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4520 {
4521 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
4522 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4523
4524 abort ();
4525 }
4526
4527 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4528
4529 static inline void
4530 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4531 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4532 {
4533 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4534
4535 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4536 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4537 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4538 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4539 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4540 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4541 }
4542
4543 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4544
4545 static inline void
4546 add_AT_float (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4547 unsigned int length, long int *array)
4548 {
4549 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4550
4551 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4552 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4553 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_float;
4554 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length = length;
4555 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array = array;
4556 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4557 }
4558
4559 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4560
4561 static hashval_t
4562 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
4563 {
4564 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
4565 }
4566
4567 static int
4568 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
4569 {
4570 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
4571 (const char *)x2) == 0;
4572 }
4573
4574 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4575
4576 static inline void
4577 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4578 {
4579 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4580 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4581 void **slot;
4582
4583 if (! debug_str_hash)
4584 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
4585 debug_str_eq, NULL);
4586
4587 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
4588 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4589 if (*slot == NULL)
4590 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
4591 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
4592 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4593 node->refcount++;
4594
4595 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4596 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4597 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4598 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4599 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4600 }
4601
4602 static inline const char *
4603 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
4604 {
4605 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4606 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4607
4608 abort ();
4609 }
4610
4611 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4612 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4613
4614 static int
4615 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
4616 {
4617 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4618 {
4619 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4620 unsigned int len;
4621 char label[32];
4622
4623 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
4624 if (node->form)
4625 return node->form;
4626
4627 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4628
4629 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4630 always better to put it inline. */
4631 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4632 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4633
4634 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4635 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4636 single module. */
4637 if ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4638 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
4639 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4640
4641 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4642 ++dw2_string_counter;
4643 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4644
4645 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4646 }
4647
4648 abort ();
4649 }
4650
4651 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4652
4653 static inline void
4654 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4655 {
4656 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4657
4658 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4659 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4660 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4661 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4662 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4663 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4664 }
4665
4666 static inline dw_die_ref
4667 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
4668 {
4669 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4670 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4671
4672 abort ();
4673 }
4674
4675 static inline int
4676 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
4677 {
4678 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4679 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4680
4681 return 0;
4682 }
4683
4684 static inline void
4685 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
4686 {
4687 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4688 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4689 else
4690 abort ();
4691 }
4692
4693 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4694
4695 static inline void
4696 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4697 {
4698 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4699
4700 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4701 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4702 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4703 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4704 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4705 }
4706
4707 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4708
4709 static inline void
4710 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4711 {
4712 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4713
4714 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4715 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4716 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4717 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4718 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4719 }
4720
4721 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4722 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
4723 {
4724 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
4725 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4726
4727 abort ();
4728 }
4729
4730 static inline void
4731 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4732 {
4733 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4734
4735 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4736 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4737 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4738 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4739 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4740 have_location_lists = 1;
4741 }
4742
4743 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4744 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
4745 {
4746 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
4747 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4748
4749 abort ();
4750 }
4751
4752 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
4753
4754 static inline void
4755 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
4756 {
4757 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4758
4759 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4760 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4761 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4762 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4763 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4764 }
4765
4766 static inline rtx
4767 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
4768 {
4769 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr)
4770 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4771
4772 abort ();
4773 }
4774
4775 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4776
4777 static inline void
4778 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
4779 {
4780 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4781
4782 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4783 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4784 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4785 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4786 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4787 }
4788
4789 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4790
4791 static inline void
4792 add_AT_lbl_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *label)
4793 {
4794 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4795
4796 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4797 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4798 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_offset;
4799 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4800 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4801 }
4802
4803 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4804
4805 static inline void
4806 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, long unsigned int offset)
4807 {
4808 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4809
4810 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4811 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4812 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4813 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4814 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4815 }
4816
4817 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
4818
4819 static void
4820 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4821 long unsigned int offset)
4822 {
4823 dw_attr_ref attr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4824
4825 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4826 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4827 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4828 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4829 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4830 }
4831
4832 static inline const char *
4833 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
4834 {
4835 if (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4836 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_offset))
4837 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4838
4839 abort ();
4840 }
4841
4842 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4843
4844 static inline dw_attr_ref
4845 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4846 {
4847 dw_attr_ref a;
4848 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4849
4850 if (die != NULL)
4851 {
4852 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
4853 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4854 return a;
4855 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4856 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4857 spec = AT_ref (a);
4858
4859 if (spec)
4860 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4861 }
4862
4863 return NULL;
4864 }
4865
4866 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4867 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4868 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4869
4870 static inline const char *
4871 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4872 {
4873 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4874
4875 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4876 }
4877
4878 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4879 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4880 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4881
4882 static inline const char *
4883 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4884 {
4885 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4886
4887 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4891 NULL if it is not present. */
4892
4893 static inline const char *
4894 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4895 {
4896 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4897
4898 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4899 }
4900
4901 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4902 if it is not present. */
4903
4904 static inline int
4905 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4906 {
4907 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4908
4909 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4910 }
4911
4912 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4913 if it is not present. */
4914
4915 static inline unsigned
4916 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4917 {
4918 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4919
4920 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4921 }
4922
4923 static inline dw_die_ref
4924 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4925 {
4926 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4927
4928 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4929 }
4930
4931 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
4932
4933 static inline bool
4934 is_c_family (void)
4935 {
4936 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4937
4938 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
4939 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
4940 }
4941
4942 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
4943
4944 static inline bool
4945 is_cxx (void)
4946 {
4947 return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
4948 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
4949 }
4950
4951 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
4952
4953 static inline bool
4954 is_fortran (void)
4955 {
4956 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4957
4958 return lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90;
4959 }
4960
4961 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
4962
4963 static inline bool
4964 is_java (void)
4965 {
4966 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4967
4968 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
4969 }
4970
4971 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
4972
4973 static inline bool
4974 is_ada (void)
4975 {
4976 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4977
4978 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
4979 }
4980
4981 /* Free up the memory used by A. */
4982
4983 static inline void free_AT (dw_attr_ref);
4984 static inline void
4985 free_AT (dw_attr_ref a)
4986 {
4987 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4988 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4989 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4990 }
4991
4992 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
4993
4994 static void
4995 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4996 {
4997 dw_attr_ref *p;
4998 dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
4999
5000 if (die != NULL)
5001 {
5002 for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
5003 if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5004 {
5005 removed = *p;
5006 *p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
5007 break;
5008 }
5009
5010 if (removed != 0)
5011 free_AT (removed);
5012 }
5013 }
5014
5015 /* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
5016
5017 static inline void
5018 free_die (dw_die_ref die)
5019 {
5020 remove_children (die);
5021 }
5022
5023 /* Discard the children of this DIE. */
5024
5025 static void
5026 remove_children (dw_die_ref die)
5027 {
5028 dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
5029
5030 die->die_child = NULL;
5031
5032 while (child_die != NULL)
5033 {
5034 dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
5035 dw_attr_ref a;
5036
5037 child_die = child_die->die_sib;
5038
5039 for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
5040 {
5041 dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
5042
5043 a = a->dw_attr_next;
5044 free_AT (tmp_a);
5045 }
5046
5047 free_die (tmp_die);
5048 }
5049 }
5050
5051 /* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
5052 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
5053
5054 static inline void
5055 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5056 {
5057 if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
5058 {
5059 if (die == child_die)
5060 abort ();
5061
5062 child_die->die_parent = die;
5063 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
5064 die->die_child = child_die;
5065 }
5066 }
5067
5068 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5069 is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
5070
5071 static void
5072 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5073 {
5074 dw_die_ref *p;
5075
5076 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5077 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5078 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5079 {
5080 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5081
5082 if (tmp)
5083 child = tmp;
5084 }
5085
5086 if (child->die_parent != parent
5087 && child->die_parent != get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification))
5088 abort ();
5089
5090 for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
5091 if (*p == child)
5092 {
5093 *p = child->die_sib;
5094 break;
5095 }
5096
5097 child->die_parent = parent;
5098 child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
5099 parent->die_child = child;
5100 }
5101
5102 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5103
5104 static inline dw_die_ref
5105 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5106 {
5107 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5108
5109 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5110
5111 if (parent_die != NULL)
5112 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5113 else
5114 {
5115 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5116
5117 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5118 limbo_node->die = die;
5119 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5120 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5121 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5122 }
5123
5124 return die;
5125 }
5126
5127 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5128
5129 static inline dw_die_ref
5130 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5131 {
5132 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5133 }
5134
5135 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5136
5137 static inline void
5138 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5139 {
5140 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5141 }
5142
5143 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5144
5145 static inline dw_die_ref
5146 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5147 {
5148 unsigned decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5149
5150 return (decl_id < decl_die_table_in_use ? decl_die_table[decl_id] : NULL);
5151 }
5152
5153 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5154
5155 static void
5156 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5157 {
5158 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5159 unsigned int num_allocated;
5160
5161 if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_allocated)
5162 {
5163 num_allocated
5164 = ((decl_id + 1 + DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT - 1)
5165 / DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT)
5166 * DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
5167
5168 decl_die_table = ggc_realloc (decl_die_table,
5169 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * num_allocated);
5170
5171 memset (&decl_die_table[decl_die_table_allocated], 0,
5172 (num_allocated - decl_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
5173 decl_die_table_allocated = num_allocated;
5174 }
5175
5176 if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_in_use)
5177 decl_die_table_in_use = (decl_id + 1);
5178
5179 decl_die_table[decl_id] = decl_die;
5180 }
5181 \f
5182 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5183 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5184 the DIE internal representation. */
5185 static int print_indent;
5186
5187 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5188
5189 static inline void
5190 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5191 {
5192 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5193 }
5194
5195 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5196 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5197
5198 static void
5199 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5200 {
5201 dw_attr_ref a;
5202 dw_die_ref c;
5203
5204 print_spaces (outfile);
5205 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5206 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5207 print_spaces (outfile);
5208 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5209 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5210
5211 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5212 {
5213 print_spaces (outfile);
5214 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5215
5216 switch (AT_class (a))
5217 {
5218 case dw_val_class_addr:
5219 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5220 break;
5221 case dw_val_class_offset:
5222 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5223 break;
5224 case dw_val_class_loc:
5225 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5226 break;
5227 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5228 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5229 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5230 break;
5231 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5232 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5233 break;
5234 case dw_val_class_const:
5235 fprintf (outfile, "%ld", AT_int (a));
5236 break;
5237 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5238 fprintf (outfile, "%lu", AT_unsigned (a));
5239 break;
5240 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5241 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5242 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5243 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5244 break;
5245 case dw_val_class_float:
5246 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point constant");
5247 break;
5248 case dw_val_class_flag:
5249 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5250 break;
5251 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5252 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5253 {
5254 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5255 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5256 else
5257 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5258 }
5259 else
5260 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5261 break;
5262 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5263 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5264 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5265 break;
5266 case dw_val_class_str:
5267 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5268 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5269 else
5270 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5271 break;
5272 default:
5273 break;
5274 }
5275
5276 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5277 }
5278
5279 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5280 {
5281 print_indent += 4;
5282 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5283 print_die (c, outfile);
5284
5285 print_indent -= 4;
5286 }
5287 if (print_indent == 0)
5288 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5289 }
5290
5291 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5292 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5293
5294 static void
5295 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5296 {
5297 unsigned i;
5298 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5299
5300 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5301 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5302 {
5303 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5304 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5305 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s",
5306 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, line_info->dw_file_num));
5307 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5308 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5309 }
5310
5311 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5312 }
5313
5314 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5315
5316 void
5317 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5318 {
5319 print_die (die, stderr);
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5323 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5324
5325 void
5326 debug_dwarf (void)
5327 {
5328 print_indent = 0;
5329 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5330 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5331 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5332 }
5333 \f
5334 /* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
5335 onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
5336 they are in order of addition. */
5337
5338 static void
5339 reverse_die_lists (dw_die_ref die)
5340 {
5341 dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
5342 dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
5343
5344 for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
5345 {
5346 an = a->dw_attr_next;
5347 a->dw_attr_next = ap;
5348 ap = a;
5349 }
5350
5351 die->die_attr = ap;
5352
5353 for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
5354 {
5355 cn = c->die_sib;
5356 c->die_sib = cp;
5357 cp = c;
5358 }
5359
5360 die->die_child = cp;
5361 }
5362
5363 /* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
5364 reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
5365 it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
5366 reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
5367 recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
5368
5369 static void
5370 reverse_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
5371 {
5372 dw_die_ref c;
5373
5374 reverse_die_lists (die);
5375
5376 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5377 reverse_all_dies (c);
5378 }
5379
5380 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5381 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5382 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5383
5384 static dw_die_ref
5385 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5386 {
5387 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5388 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5389
5390 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5391 return new_unit;
5392 }
5393
5394 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5395
5396 static dw_die_ref
5397 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5398 {
5399 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5400
5401 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5402 return new_unit;
5403 }
5404
5405 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5406 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5407
5408 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5409
5410 static inline void
5411 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5412 {
5413 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5414 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5415 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5416 }
5417
5418 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5419
5420 static void
5421 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5422 {
5423 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5424 rtx r;
5425
5426 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5427
5428 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5429 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5430 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5431 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5432 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5433 return;
5434
5435 switch (AT_class (at))
5436 {
5437 case dw_val_class_const:
5438 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5439 break;
5440 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5441 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5442 break;
5443 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5444 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5445 break;
5446 case dw_val_class_float:
5447 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_float);
5448 break;
5449 case dw_val_class_flag:
5450 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5451 break;
5452 case dw_val_class_str:
5453 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5454 break;
5455
5456 case dw_val_class_addr:
5457 r = AT_addr (at);
5458 switch (GET_CODE (r))
5459 {
5460 case SYMBOL_REF:
5461 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5462 break;
5463
5464 default:
5465 abort ();
5466 }
5467 break;
5468
5469 case dw_val_class_offset:
5470 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5471 break;
5472
5473 case dw_val_class_loc:
5474 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5475 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5476 break;
5477
5478 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5479 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5480 break;
5481
5482 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5483 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5484 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5485 break;
5486
5487 default:
5488 break;
5489 }
5490 }
5491
5492 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5493
5494 static void
5495 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5496 {
5497 dw_die_ref c;
5498 dw_attr_ref a;
5499
5500 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5501 if (die->die_mark)
5502 {
5503 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
5504 return;
5505 }
5506 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5507
5508 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5509
5510 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5511 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
5512
5513 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5514 die_checksum (c, ctx, mark);
5515 }
5516
5517 #undef CHECKSUM
5518 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5519
5520 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
5521 static inline int
5522 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
5523 {
5524 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
5525 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
5526 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
5527 }
5528
5529 /* Do the values look the same? */
5530 static int
5531 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
5532 {
5533 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
5534 rtx r1, r2;
5535 unsigned i;
5536
5537 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
5538 return 0;
5539
5540 switch (v1->val_class)
5541 {
5542 case dw_val_class_const:
5543 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
5544 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5545 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
5546 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5547 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
5548 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
5549 case dw_val_class_float:
5550 if (v1->v.val_float.length != v2->v.val_float.length)
5551 return 0;
5552 for (i = 0; i < v1->v.val_float.length; i++)
5553 if (v1->v.val_float.array[i] != v2->v.val_float.array[i])
5554 return 0;
5555 return 1;
5556 case dw_val_class_flag:
5557 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
5558 case dw_val_class_str:
5559 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
5560
5561 case dw_val_class_addr:
5562 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
5563 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
5564 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
5565 return 0;
5566 switch (GET_CODE (r1))
5567 {
5568 case SYMBOL_REF:
5569 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
5570
5571 default:
5572 abort ();
5573 }
5574
5575 case dw_val_class_offset:
5576 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
5577
5578 case dw_val_class_loc:
5579 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
5580 loc1 && loc2;
5581 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
5582 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
5583 return 0;
5584 return !loc1 && !loc2;
5585
5586 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5587 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
5588
5589 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5590 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5591 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5592 return 1;
5593
5594 default:
5595 return 1;
5596 }
5597 }
5598
5599 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
5600
5601 static int
5602 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
5603 {
5604 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
5605 return 0;
5606
5607 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5608 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5609 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5610 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5611 || at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5612 return 1;
5613
5614 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
5615 }
5616
5617 /* Do the dies look the same? */
5618
5619 static int
5620 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
5621 {
5622 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
5623 dw_attr_ref a1, a2;
5624
5625 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
5626 if (die1->die_mark)
5627 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
5628 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
5629
5630 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
5631 return 0;
5632
5633 for (a1 = die1->die_attr, a2 = die2->die_attr;
5634 a1 && a2;
5635 a1 = a1->dw_attr_next, a2 = a2->dw_attr_next)
5636 if (!same_attr_p (a1, a2, mark))
5637 return 0;
5638 if (a1 || a2)
5639 return 0;
5640
5641 for (c1 = die1->die_child, c2 = die2->die_child;
5642 c1 && c2;
5643 c1 = c1->die_sib, c2 = c2->die_sib)
5644 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
5645 return 0;
5646 if (c1 || c2)
5647 return 0;
5648
5649 return 1;
5650 }
5651
5652 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
5653
5654 static int
5655 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
5656 {
5657 int mark = 0;
5658 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
5659
5660 unmark_all_dies (die1);
5661 unmark_all_dies (die2);
5662
5663 return ret;
5664 }
5665
5666 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
5667 info section. */
5668 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
5669
5670 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
5671 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
5672
5673 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
5674 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
5675
5676 static void
5677 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
5678 {
5679 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
5680 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
5681 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
5682 char *p;
5683 int i, mark;
5684 unsigned char checksum[16];
5685 struct md5_ctx ctx;
5686
5687 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
5688 the name filename of the unit. */
5689
5690 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
5691 mark = 0;
5692 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
5693 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
5694 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
5695
5696 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
5697 clean_symbol_name (name);
5698
5699 p = name + strlen (name);
5700 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
5701 {
5702 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
5703 p += 2;
5704 }
5705
5706 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
5707 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
5708 }
5709
5710 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
5711
5712 static int
5713 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
5714 {
5715 switch (die->die_tag)
5716 {
5717 case DW_TAG_array_type:
5718 case DW_TAG_class_type:
5719 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
5720 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
5721 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
5722 case DW_TAG_string_type:
5723 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
5724 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
5725 case DW_TAG_union_type:
5726 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
5727 case DW_TAG_set_type:
5728 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
5729 case DW_TAG_base_type:
5730 case DW_TAG_const_type:
5731 case DW_TAG_file_type:
5732 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
5733 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
5734 case DW_TAG_typedef:
5735 return 1;
5736 default:
5737 return 0;
5738 }
5739 }
5740
5741 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
5742 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
5743 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
5744 compilations (functions). */
5745
5746 static int
5747 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
5748 {
5749 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
5750 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
5751 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
5752 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
5753
5754 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
5755 return 0;
5756
5757 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
5758 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
5759 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
5760 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
5761 {
5762 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
5763
5764 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
5765 }
5766
5767 return is_type_die (c);
5768 }
5769
5770 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
5771 compilation unit. */
5772
5773 static int
5774 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
5775 {
5776 return (is_type_die (c)
5777 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
5778 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
5779 }
5780
5781 static char *
5782 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
5783 {
5784 char buf[256];
5785
5786 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
5787 return xstrdup (buf);
5788 }
5789
5790 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
5791
5792 static void
5793 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
5794 {
5795 dw_die_ref c;
5796
5797 if (is_symbol_die (die))
5798 {
5799 if (comdat_symbol_id)
5800 {
5801 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
5802
5803 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
5804 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
5805 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
5806 }
5807 else
5808 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
5809 }
5810
5811 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5812 assign_symbol_names (c);
5813 }
5814
5815 struct cu_hash_table_entry
5816 {
5817 dw_die_ref cu;
5818 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
5819 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
5820 };
5821
5822 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
5823 static hashval_t
5824 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
5825 {
5826 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
5827
5828 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
5829 }
5830
5831 static int
5832 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
5833 {
5834 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
5835 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
5836
5837 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
5838 }
5839
5840 static void
5841 htab_cu_del (void *what)
5842 {
5843 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
5844
5845 while (entry)
5846 {
5847 next = entry->next;
5848 free (entry);
5849 entry = next;
5850 }
5851 }
5852
5853 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
5854 accordingly. */
5855 static int
5856 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
5857 {
5858 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
5859 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
5860
5861 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
5862
5863 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
5864 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
5865 INSERT);
5866 entry = *slot;
5867
5868 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
5869 {
5870 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
5871 break;
5872 }
5873
5874 if (entry)
5875 {
5876 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
5877 return 1;
5878 }
5879
5880 entry = xcalloc (1, sizeof (struct cu_hash_table_entry));
5881 entry->cu = cu;
5882 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
5883 entry->next = *slot;
5884 *slot = entry;
5885
5886 return 0;
5887 }
5888
5889 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
5890 static void
5891 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
5892 {
5893 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
5894
5895 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
5896 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
5897 NO_INSERT);
5898 entry = *slot;
5899
5900 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
5901 }
5902
5903 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
5904 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
5905 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
5906
5907 static void
5908 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
5909 {
5910 dw_die_ref *ptr;
5911 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
5912 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
5913 htab_t cu_hash_table;
5914
5915 for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr;)
5916 {
5917 dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
5918
5919 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
5920 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
5921 {
5922 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
5923 *ptr = c->die_sib;
5924
5925 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
5926 {
5927 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
5928 free_die (c);
5929 }
5930 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
5931 {
5932 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
5933 free_die (c);
5934 }
5935 else
5936 add_child_die (unit, c);
5937 }
5938 else
5939 {
5940 /* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
5941 ptr = &(c->die_sib);
5942 continue;
5943 }
5944 }
5945
5946 #if 0
5947 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
5948 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
5949 if (unit != NULL)
5950 abort ();
5951 #endif
5952
5953 assign_symbol_names (die);
5954 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
5955 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
5956 node;
5957 node = node->next)
5958 {
5959 int is_dupl;
5960
5961 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
5962 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
5963 &comdat_symbol_number);
5964 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
5965 if (is_dupl)
5966 *pnode = node->next;
5967 else
5968 {
5969 pnode = &node->next;
5970 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
5971 comdat_symbol_number);
5972 }
5973 }
5974 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
5975 }
5976
5977 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
5978 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
5979 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
5980
5981 static void
5982 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
5983 {
5984 dw_die_ref c;
5985
5986 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5987 && die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
5988 /* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
5989 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
5990
5991 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5992 add_sibling_attributes (c);
5993 }
5994
5995 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
5996
5997 static void
5998 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
5999 {
6000 dw_die_ref c;
6001 dw_attr_ref d_attr;
6002
6003 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6004 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6005 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
6006
6007 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6008 output_location_lists (c);
6009
6010 }
6011
6012 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6013 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6014 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6015 die are visited recursively. */
6016
6017 static void
6018 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6019 {
6020 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6021 unsigned int n_alloc;
6022 dw_die_ref c;
6023 dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
6024
6025 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6026 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6027 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
6028 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6029 && AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
6030 {
6031 if (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol == 0)
6032 abort ();
6033
6034 set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
6035 }
6036
6037 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6038 {
6039 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6040
6041 if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
6042 {
6043 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
6044 {
6045 a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
6046 d_attr = die->die_attr;
6047
6048 while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
6049 {
6050 if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
6051 || (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
6052 break;
6053
6054 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
6055 d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
6056 }
6057
6058 if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
6059 break;
6060 }
6061 }
6062 }
6063
6064 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6065 {
6066 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6067 {
6068 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6069 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6070 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6071
6072 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6073 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6074 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6075 }
6076
6077 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6078 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6079 }
6080
6081 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6082 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6083 build_abbrev_table (c);
6084 }
6085 \f
6086 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6087
6088 static int
6089 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6090 {
6091 int log;
6092
6093 if (value == 0)
6094 log = 0;
6095 else
6096 log = floor_log2 (value);
6097
6098 log = log / 8;
6099 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6100
6101 return log;
6102 }
6103
6104 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6105 .debug_info section. */
6106
6107 static unsigned long
6108 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6109 {
6110 unsigned long size = 0;
6111 dw_attr_ref a;
6112
6113 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6114 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6115 {
6116 switch (AT_class (a))
6117 {
6118 case dw_val_class_addr:
6119 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6120 break;
6121 case dw_val_class_offset:
6122 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6123 break;
6124 case dw_val_class_loc:
6125 {
6126 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6127
6128 /* Block length. */
6129 size += constant_size (lsize);
6130 size += lsize;
6131 }
6132 break;
6133 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6134 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6135 break;
6136 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6137 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6138 break;
6139 case dw_val_class_const:
6140 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6141 break;
6142 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6143 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6144 break;
6145 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6146 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6147 break;
6148 case dw_val_class_float:
6149 size += 1 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4; /* block */
6150 break;
6151 case dw_val_class_flag:
6152 size += 1;
6153 break;
6154 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6155 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6156 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6157 else
6158 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6159 break;
6160 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6161 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6162 break;
6163 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6164 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6165 break;
6166 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6167 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6168 break;
6169 case dw_val_class_str:
6170 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6171 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6172 else
6173 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6174 break;
6175 default:
6176 abort ();
6177 }
6178 }
6179
6180 return size;
6181 }
6182
6183 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6184 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6185 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6186 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6187
6188 static void
6189 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6190 {
6191 dw_die_ref c;
6192
6193 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6194 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6195
6196 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6197 calc_die_sizes (c);
6198
6199 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6200 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6201 next_die_offset += 1;
6202 }
6203
6204 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6205 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6206 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6207 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6208
6209 static void
6210 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6211 {
6212 dw_die_ref c;
6213
6214 if (die->die_mark)
6215 abort ();
6216
6217 die->die_mark = 1;
6218 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6219 mark_dies (c);
6220 }
6221
6222 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6223
6224 static void
6225 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6226 {
6227 dw_die_ref c;
6228
6229 if (!die->die_mark)
6230 abort ();
6231
6232 die->die_mark = 0;
6233 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6234 unmark_dies (c);
6235 }
6236
6237 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6238
6239 static void
6240 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6241 {
6242 dw_die_ref c;
6243 dw_attr_ref a;
6244
6245 if (!die->die_mark)
6246 return;
6247 die->die_mark = 0;
6248
6249 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
6250 unmark_all_dies (c);
6251
6252 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6253 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6254 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6255 }
6256
6257 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
6258 compilation unit. */
6259
6260 static unsigned long
6261 size_of_pubnames (void)
6262 {
6263 unsigned long size;
6264 unsigned i;
6265
6266 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6267 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6268 {
6269 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
6270 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
6271 }
6272
6273 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6274 return size;
6275 }
6276
6277 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6278
6279 static unsigned long
6280 size_of_aranges (void)
6281 {
6282 unsigned long size;
6283
6284 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6285
6286 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6287 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6288 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6289
6290 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6291 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6292 return size;
6293 }
6294 \f
6295 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6296
6297 static enum dwarf_form
6298 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6299 {
6300 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6301 {
6302 case dw_val_class_addr:
6303 return DW_FORM_addr;
6304 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6305 case dw_val_class_offset:
6306 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
6307 return DW_FORM_data4;
6308 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
6309 return DW_FORM_data8;
6310 abort ();
6311 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6312 /* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
6313 .debug_loc section */
6314 return DW_FORM_data4;
6315 case dw_val_class_loc:
6316 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6317 {
6318 case 1:
6319 return DW_FORM_block1;
6320 case 2:
6321 return DW_FORM_block2;
6322 default:
6323 abort ();
6324 }
6325 case dw_val_class_const:
6326 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6327 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6328 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6329 {
6330 case 1:
6331 return DW_FORM_data1;
6332 case 2:
6333 return DW_FORM_data2;
6334 case 4:
6335 return DW_FORM_data4;
6336 case 8:
6337 return DW_FORM_data8;
6338 default:
6339 abort ();
6340 }
6341 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6342 return DW_FORM_block1;
6343 case dw_val_class_float:
6344 return DW_FORM_block1;
6345 case dw_val_class_flag:
6346 return DW_FORM_flag;
6347 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6348 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6349 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6350 else
6351 return DW_FORM_ref;
6352 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6353 return DW_FORM_data;
6354 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6355 return DW_FORM_addr;
6356 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6357 return DW_FORM_data;
6358 case dw_val_class_str:
6359 return AT_string_form (a);
6360
6361 default:
6362 abort ();
6363 }
6364 }
6365
6366 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6367
6368 static void
6369 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6370 {
6371 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6372
6373 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6374 }
6375
6376 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6377 table. */
6378
6379 static void
6380 output_abbrev_section (void)
6381 {
6382 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6383
6384 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6385
6386 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6387 {
6388 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6389
6390 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6391 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6392 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6393
6394 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6395 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6396 else
6397 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6398
6399 for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
6400 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
6401 {
6402 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6403 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6404 output_value_format (a_attr);
6405 }
6406
6407 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6408 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6409 }
6410
6411 /* Terminate the table. */
6412 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6413 }
6414
6415 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6416
6417 static inline void
6418 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6419 {
6420 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6421
6422 if (sym == 0)
6423 return;
6424
6425 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6426 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6427 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6428 will break. */
6429 (*targetm.asm_out.globalize_label) (asm_out_file, sym);
6430
6431 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6432 }
6433
6434 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6435 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6436 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6437
6438 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6439 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6440 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6441 {
6442 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6443
6444 retlist->begin = begin;
6445 retlist->end = end;
6446 retlist->expr = expr;
6447 retlist->section = section;
6448 if (gensym)
6449 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6450
6451 return retlist;
6452 }
6453
6454 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6455
6456 static inline void
6457 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6458 const char *begin, const char *end,
6459 const char *section)
6460 {
6461 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6462
6463 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6464 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6465 ;
6466
6467 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6468 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6469 }
6470
6471 /* Output the location list given to us. */
6472
6473 static void
6474 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
6475 {
6476 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6477
6478 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6479
6480 /* ??? This shouldn't be needed now that we've forced the
6481 compilation unit base address to zero when there is code
6482 in more than one section. */
6483 if (strcmp (curr->section, ".text") == 0)
6484 {
6485 /* dw2_asm_output_data will mask off any extra bits in the ~0. */
6486 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
6487 "Location list base address specifier fake entry");
6488 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->section,
6489 "Location list base address specifier base");
6490 }
6491
6492 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
6493 {
6494 unsigned long size;
6495
6496 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6497 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6498 list_head->ll_symbol);
6499 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6500 "Location list end address (%s)",
6501 list_head->ll_symbol);
6502 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6503
6504 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6505 if (size > 0xffff)
6506 abort ();
6507 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6508
6509 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
6510 }
6511
6512 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
6513 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
6514 list_head->ll_symbol);
6515 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
6516 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
6517 list_head->ll_symbol);
6518 }
6519
6520 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
6521 the definitions of each child DIE. */
6522
6523 static void
6524 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
6525 {
6526 dw_attr_ref a;
6527 dw_die_ref c;
6528 unsigned long size;
6529
6530 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
6531 them to point to. */
6532 if (die->die_symbol)
6533 output_die_symbol (die);
6534
6535 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
6536 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
6537
6538 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6539 {
6540 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
6541
6542 switch (AT_class (a))
6543 {
6544 case dw_val_class_addr:
6545 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
6546 break;
6547
6548 case dw_val_class_offset:
6549 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
6550 "%s", name);
6551 break;
6552
6553 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6554 {
6555 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
6556
6557 sprintf (p, "+0x%lx", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6558 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
6559 "%s", name);
6560 *p = '\0';
6561 }
6562 break;
6563
6564 case dw_val_class_loc:
6565 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6566
6567 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6568 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
6569
6570 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
6571 break;
6572
6573 case dw_val_class_const:
6574 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
6575 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
6576 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
6577 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
6578 break;
6579
6580 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6581 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
6582 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
6583 break;
6584
6585 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6586 {
6587 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
6588
6589 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
6590 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6591 "%s", name);
6592
6593 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6594 {
6595 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6596 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6597 }
6598 else
6599 {
6600 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6601 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6602 }
6603
6604 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6605 first, "long long constant");
6606 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6607 second, NULL);
6608 }
6609 break;
6610
6611 case dw_val_class_float:
6612 {
6613 unsigned int i;
6614
6615 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4,
6616 "%s", name);
6617
6618 for (i = 0; i < a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length; i++)
6619 dw2_asm_output_data (4, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array[i],
6620 "fp constant word %u", i);
6621 break;
6622 }
6623
6624 case dw_val_class_flag:
6625 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
6626 break;
6627
6628 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6629 {
6630 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
6631
6632 if (sym == 0)
6633 abort ();
6634 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym,
6635 loc_section_label, "%s", name);
6636 }
6637 break;
6638
6639 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6640 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6641 {
6642 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
6643
6644 if (sym == 0)
6645 abort ();
6646 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
6647 }
6648 else if (AT_ref (a)->die_offset == 0)
6649 abort ();
6650 else
6651 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
6652 "%s", name);
6653 break;
6654
6655 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6656 {
6657 char l1[20];
6658
6659 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
6660 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
6661 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, "%s", name);
6662 }
6663 break;
6664
6665 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6666 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
6667 break;
6668
6669 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6670 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
6671 break;
6672
6673 case dw_val_class_str:
6674 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6675 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
6676 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
6677 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
6678 else
6679 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
6680 break;
6681
6682 default:
6683 abort ();
6684 }
6685 }
6686
6687 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6688 output_die (c);
6689
6690 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
6691 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6692 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
6693 die->die_offset);
6694 }
6695
6696 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
6697 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
6698
6699 static void
6700 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
6701 {
6702 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
6703 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
6704 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
6705 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
6706 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
6707 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
6708 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
6709 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
6710 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
6711 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
6712 }
6713
6714 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
6715
6716 static void
6717 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
6718 {
6719 const char *secname;
6720 char *oldsym, *tmp;
6721
6722 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
6723 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
6724 return;
6725
6726 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
6727 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
6728 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
6729 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
6730 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
6731 mark_dies (die);
6732
6733 build_abbrev_table (die);
6734
6735 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
6736 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
6737 calc_die_sizes (die);
6738
6739 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
6740 if (oldsym)
6741 {
6742 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
6743
6744 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
6745 secname = tmp;
6746 die->die_symbol = NULL;
6747 }
6748 else
6749 secname = (const char *) DEBUG_INFO_SECTION;
6750
6751 /* Output debugging information. */
6752 named_section_flags (secname, SECTION_DEBUG);
6753 output_compilation_unit_header ();
6754 output_die (die);
6755
6756 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
6757 output_pubnames. */
6758 if (oldsym)
6759 {
6760 unmark_dies (die);
6761 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
6762 }
6763 }
6764
6765 /* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The
6766 output of lang_hooks.decl_printable_name for C++ looks like
6767 "A::f(int)". Let's drop the argument list, and maybe the scope. */
6768
6769 static const char *
6770 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
6771 {
6772 return (*lang_hooks.decl_printable_name) (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
6773 }
6774
6775 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
6776
6777 static void
6778 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
6779 {
6780 pubname_ref p;
6781
6782 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
6783 return;
6784
6785 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
6786 {
6787 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6788 pubname_table
6789 = ggc_realloc (pubname_table,
6790 (pubname_table_allocated * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
6791 memset (pubname_table + pubname_table_in_use, 0,
6792 PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (pubname_entry));
6793 }
6794
6795 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
6796 p->die = die;
6797 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
6798 }
6799
6800 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
6801 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
6802 visible procedures. */
6803
6804 static void
6805 output_pubnames (void)
6806 {
6807 unsigned i;
6808 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
6809
6810 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
6811 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
6812 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
6813 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
6814 "Length of Public Names Info");
6815 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
6816 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
6817 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
6818 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
6819 "Compilation Unit Length");
6820
6821 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6822 {
6823 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
6824
6825 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
6826 if (pub->die->die_mark == 0)
6827 abort ();
6828
6829 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
6830 "DIE offset");
6831
6832 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
6833 }
6834
6835 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6836 }
6837
6838 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
6839
6840 static void
6841 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
6842 {
6843 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
6844 return;
6845
6846 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
6847 {
6848 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6849 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
6850 (arange_table_allocated
6851 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
6852 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
6853 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6854 }
6855
6856 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
6857 }
6858
6859 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
6860 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
6861 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
6862
6863 static void
6864 output_aranges (void)
6865 {
6866 unsigned i;
6867 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
6868
6869 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
6870 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
6871 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
6872 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
6873 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
6874 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
6875 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
6876 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
6877 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
6878 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
6879
6880 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
6881 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
6882 {
6883 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
6884 pointer size. */
6885 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
6886 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6887 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
6888 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
6889 }
6890
6891 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
6892 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
6893 text_section_label, "Length");
6894
6895 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
6896 {
6897 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
6898
6899 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
6900 if (die->die_mark == 0)
6901 abort ();
6902
6903 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
6904 {
6905 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
6906 "Address");
6907 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
6908 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
6909 }
6910 else
6911 {
6912 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
6913 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
6914 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
6915 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
6916 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6917
6918 if (! a || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
6919 abort ();
6920
6921 loc = AT_loc (a);
6922 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_addr)
6923 abort ();
6924
6925 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
6926 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
6927 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
6928 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
6929 "Length");
6930 }
6931 }
6932
6933 /* Output the terminator words. */
6934 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6935 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6936 }
6937
6938 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
6939 was placed. */
6940
6941 static unsigned int
6942 add_ranges (tree block)
6943 {
6944 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
6945
6946 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
6947 {
6948 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6949 ranges_table
6950 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
6951 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
6952 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
6953 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
6954 }
6955
6956 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
6957 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
6958
6959 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6960 }
6961
6962 static void
6963 output_ranges (void)
6964 {
6965 unsigned i;
6966 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
6967 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
6968
6969 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
6970 {
6971 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
6972
6973 if (block_num)
6974 {
6975 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6976 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6977
6978 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
6979 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
6980
6981 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
6982 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
6983 base of the text section. */
6984 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
6985 {
6986 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
6987 text_section_label,
6988 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6989 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
6990 text_section_label, NULL);
6991 }
6992
6993 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
6994 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
6995 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
6996 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
6997 else
6998 {
6999 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7000 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7001 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7002 }
7003
7004 fmt = NULL;
7005 }
7006 else
7007 {
7008 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7009 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7010 fmt = start_fmt;
7011 }
7012 }
7013 }
7014
7015 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7016 struct file_info
7017 {
7018 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7019 char *fname; /* File name part. */
7020 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7021 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7022 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7023 };
7024
7025 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7026 files. */
7027 struct dir_info
7028 {
7029 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7030 int length; /* Path length. */
7031 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7032 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7033 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7034 int used; /* Used in the end? */
7035 };
7036
7037 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7038 the directories in the path. */
7039
7040 static int
7041 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7042 {
7043 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7044 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7045 unsigned char *cp1;
7046 unsigned char *cp2;
7047
7048 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7049 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7050 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7051 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7052 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7053 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7054 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7055
7056 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7057 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7058
7059 while (1)
7060 {
7061 ++cp1;
7062 ++cp2;
7063 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7064 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7065 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7066 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7067 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7068
7069 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7070 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7071 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7072 }
7073 }
7074
7075 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7076 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7077 slowdowns with many input files. */
7078
7079 static void
7080 output_file_names (void)
7081 {
7082 struct file_info *files;
7083 struct dir_info *dirs;
7084 int *saved;
7085 int *savehere;
7086 int *backmap;
7087 size_t ndirs;
7088 int idx_offset;
7089 size_t i;
7090 int idx;
7091
7092 /* Handle the case where file_table is empty. */
7093 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) <= 1)
7094 {
7095 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7096 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7097 return;
7098 }
7099
7100 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7101 files = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct file_info));
7102 dirs = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7103
7104 /* Sort the file names. */
7105 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7106 {
7107 char *f;
7108
7109 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7110 f = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i);
7111 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7112 f += 2;
7113
7114 /* Create a new array entry. */
7115 files[i].path = f;
7116 files[i].length = strlen (f);
7117 files[i].file_idx = i;
7118
7119 /* Search for the file name part. */
7120 f = strrchr (f, '/');
7121 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
7122 }
7123
7124 qsort (files + 1, VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) - 1,
7125 sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7126
7127 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7128 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
7129 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
7130 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7131 dirs[0].count = 1;
7132 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7133 dirs[0].used = 0;
7134 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
7135 ndirs = 1;
7136
7137 for (i = 2; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7138 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7139 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7140 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7141 {
7142 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7143 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7144 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7145 }
7146 else
7147 {
7148 size_t j;
7149
7150 /* This is a new directory. */
7151 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7152 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7153 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7154 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7155 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
7156 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7157
7158 /* Search for a prefix. */
7159 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7160 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7161 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7162 && dirs[j].length > 1
7163 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7164 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7165 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7166 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7167
7168 ++ndirs;
7169 }
7170
7171 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7172 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7173 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7174 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7175 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7176 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7177 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7178 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7179
7180 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7181 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7182 {
7183 size_t j;
7184 int total;
7185
7186 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7187 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7188 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7189 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7190
7191 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7192 {
7193 savehere[j] = 0;
7194 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7195 {
7196 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7197 dirs[j] path. */
7198 int k;
7199
7200 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7201 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7202 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7203
7204 if (k == (int) i)
7205 {
7206 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
7207 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7208 dirs[i]. */
7209 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7210 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7211 }
7212 }
7213 }
7214
7215 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7216 directory. */
7217 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7218 {
7219 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7220 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7221 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7222 {
7223 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7224 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7225
7226 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7227 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7228 }
7229 }
7230 }
7231
7232 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
7233 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
7234 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7235 backmap = alloca (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table) * sizeof (int));
7236 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7237 {
7238 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
7239
7240 /* Mark this directory as used. */
7241 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
7242 }
7243
7244 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
7245 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
7246 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
7247 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
7248 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
7249 idx = 1;
7250 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7251 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7252 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
7253 {
7254 dirs[i].used = idx++;
7255 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7256 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
7257 }
7258
7259 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7260
7261 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
7262 exists. */
7263 if (idx_offset == 0)
7264 dirs[0].used = 0;
7265
7266 /* Now write all the file names. */
7267 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
7268 {
7269 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7270 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7271
7272 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7273 "File Entry: 0x%lx", (unsigned long) i);
7274
7275 /* Include directory index. */
7276 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
7277
7278 /* Modification time. */
7279 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7280
7281 /* File length in bytes. */
7282 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7283 }
7284
7285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7286 }
7287
7288
7289 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7290 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7291
7292 static void
7293 output_line_info (void)
7294 {
7295 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7296 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7297 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7298 unsigned opc;
7299 unsigned n_op_args;
7300 unsigned long lt_index;
7301 unsigned long current_line;
7302 long line_offset;
7303 long line_delta;
7304 unsigned long current_file;
7305 unsigned long function;
7306
7307 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7308 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7309 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7310 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7311
7312 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7313 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7314 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7315 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7316 "Length of Source Line Info");
7317 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7318
7319 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7320 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7321 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7322
7323 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7324 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7325 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7326 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7327 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7328 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7329 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7330 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7331 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7332 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7333
7334 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7335 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7336 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7337 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7338 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7339 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7340 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7341 "Special Opcode Base");
7342
7343 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7344 {
7345 switch (opc)
7346 {
7347 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7348 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7349 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7350 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7351 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7352 n_op_args = 1;
7353 break;
7354 default:
7355 n_op_args = 0;
7356 break;
7357 }
7358
7359 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7360 opc, n_op_args);
7361 }
7362
7363 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7364 output_file_names ();
7365 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7366
7367 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7368 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7369 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7370
7371 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7372 a series of state machine operations. */
7373 current_file = 1;
7374 current_line = 1;
7375 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7376 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7377 {
7378 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7379
7380 #if 0
7381 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7382 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7383 prologue. */
7384
7385 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7386 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7387 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7388 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7389 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7390 continue;
7391 #endif
7392
7393 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7394
7395 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7396 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7397 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7398 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7399 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7400 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7401
7402 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7403 if (0)
7404 {
7405 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7406 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7407 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7408 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7409 }
7410 else
7411 {
7412 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7413 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7414 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7415 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7416 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7417 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7418 }
7419
7420 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7421
7422 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7423 different from the previous line. */
7424 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7425 {
7426 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7427 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7428 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7429 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7430 current_file));
7431 }
7432
7433 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7434 that uses the least amount of space. */
7435 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7436 {
7437 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7438 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7439 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7440 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7441 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7442 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7443 takes 1 byte. */
7444 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7445 "line %lu", current_line);
7446 else
7447 {
7448 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7449 depending on the value being encoded. */
7450 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7451 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7452 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7453 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7454 }
7455 }
7456 else
7457 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7458 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7459 }
7460
7461 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7462 if (0)
7463 {
7464 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7465 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7466 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7467 }
7468 else
7469 {
7470 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7471 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7472 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7473 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7474 }
7475
7476 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7477 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7478 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7479
7480 function = 0;
7481 current_file = 1;
7482 current_line = 1;
7483 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
7484 {
7485 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
7486 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
7487
7488 #if 0
7489 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
7490 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7491 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
7492 && line_info->function == function)
7493 goto cont;
7494 #endif
7495
7496 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
7497 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
7498 to handle it differently. */
7499 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
7500 lt_index);
7501 if (function != line_info->function)
7502 {
7503 function = line_info->function;
7504
7505 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
7506 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7507 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7508 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7509 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7510 }
7511 else
7512 {
7513 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
7514 if (0)
7515 {
7516 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7517 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7518 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7519 }
7520 else
7521 {
7522 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7523 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7524 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7525 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7526 }
7527 }
7528
7529 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7530
7531 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7532 different from the previous line. */
7533 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7534 {
7535 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7536 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7537 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7538 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table,
7539 current_file));
7540 }
7541
7542 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7543 that uses the least amount of space. */
7544 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7545 {
7546 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7547 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7548 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7549 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7550 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7551 "line %lu", current_line);
7552 else
7553 {
7554 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7555 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7556 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7557 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7558 }
7559 }
7560 else
7561 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7562
7563 #if 0
7564 cont:
7565 #endif
7566
7567 lt_index++;
7568
7569 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
7570 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
7571 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
7572 {
7573 current_file = 1;
7574 current_line = 1;
7575
7576 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7577 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
7578 if (0)
7579 {
7580 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7581 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7582 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7583 }
7584 else
7585 {
7586 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7587 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7588 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7589 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7590 }
7591
7592 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
7593 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7594 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7595 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7596 }
7597 }
7598
7599 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
7600 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
7601 }
7602 \f
7603 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
7604 a DIE that describes the given type.
7605
7606 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
7607 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
7608
7609 static dw_die_ref
7610 base_type_die (tree type)
7611 {
7612 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
7613 const char *type_name;
7614 enum dwarf_type encoding;
7615 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
7616
7617 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
7618 return 0;
7619
7620 if (name)
7621 {
7622 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
7623 name = DECL_NAME (name);
7624
7625 type_name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name);
7626 }
7627 else
7628 type_name = "__unknown__";
7629
7630 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7631 {
7632 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7633 /* Carefully distinguish the C character types, without messing
7634 up if the language is not C. Note that we check only for the names
7635 that contain spaces; other names might occur by coincidence in other
7636 languages. */
7637 if (! (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
7638 && (type == char_type_node
7639 || ! strcmp (type_name, "signed char")
7640 || ! strcmp (type_name, "unsigned char"))))
7641 {
7642 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7643 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
7644 else
7645 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
7646 break;
7647 }
7648 /* else fall through. */
7649
7650 case CHAR_TYPE:
7651 /* GNU Pascal/Ada CHAR type. Not used in C. */
7652 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7653 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
7654 else
7655 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
7656 break;
7657
7658 case REAL_TYPE:
7659 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
7660 break;
7661
7662 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
7663 a user defined type for it. */
7664 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7665 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
7666 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
7667 else
7668 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
7669 break;
7670
7671 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7672 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
7673 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
7674 break;
7675
7676 default:
7677 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
7678 abort ();
7679 }
7680
7681 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7682 if (demangle_name_func)
7683 type_name = (*demangle_name_func) (type_name);
7684
7685 add_AT_string (base_type_result, DW_AT_name, type_name);
7686 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
7687 int_size_in_bytes (type));
7688 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
7689
7690 return base_type_result;
7691 }
7692
7693 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
7694 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
7695 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
7696 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
7697 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
7698 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
7699 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
7700 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
7701
7702 static tree
7703 root_type (tree type)
7704 {
7705 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
7706 return error_mark_node;
7707
7708 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7709 {
7710 case ERROR_MARK:
7711 return error_mark_node;
7712
7713 case POINTER_TYPE:
7714 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7715 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
7716
7717 default:
7718 return type_main_variant (type);
7719 }
7720 }
7721
7722 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
7723 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
7724
7725 static inline int
7726 is_base_type (tree type)
7727 {
7728 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7729 {
7730 case ERROR_MARK:
7731 case VOID_TYPE:
7732 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7733 case REAL_TYPE:
7734 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7735 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7736 case CHAR_TYPE:
7737 return 1;
7738
7739 case SET_TYPE:
7740 case ARRAY_TYPE:
7741 case RECORD_TYPE:
7742 case UNION_TYPE:
7743 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
7744 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
7745 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
7746 case METHOD_TYPE:
7747 case POINTER_TYPE:
7748 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7749 case FILE_TYPE:
7750 case OFFSET_TYPE:
7751 case LANG_TYPE:
7752 case VECTOR_TYPE:
7753 return 0;
7754
7755 default:
7756 abort ();
7757 }
7758
7759 return 0;
7760 }
7761
7762 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
7763 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
7764 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
7765 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
7766 ERROR_MARK node. */
7767
7768 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7769 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
7770 {
7771 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
7772 return BITS_PER_WORD;
7773 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
7774 return 0;
7775 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
7776 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
7777 else
7778 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
7779 }
7780
7781 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
7782 emitted as a subrange type. */
7783
7784 static inline bool
7785 is_ada_subrange_type (tree type)
7786 {
7787 /* We do this for INTEGER_TYPEs that have names, parent types, and when
7788 we are compiling Ada code. */
7789 return (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
7790 && TYPE_NAME (type) != 0 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0
7791 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == INTEGER_TYPE
7792 && TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (type)) && is_ada ());
7793 }
7794
7795 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
7796 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
7797
7798 static dw_die_ref
7799 subrange_type_die (tree type)
7800 {
7801 dw_die_ref subtype_die;
7802 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
7803 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
7804
7805 subtype_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type));
7806
7807 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
7808 name = DECL_NAME (name);
7809
7810 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7811 add_name_attribute (subrange_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
7812 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
7813 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
7814 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
7815 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
7816 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
7817 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
7818 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, DW_AT_type, subtype_die);
7819
7820 return subrange_die;
7821 }
7822
7823 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
7824 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
7825
7826 static dw_die_ref
7827 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
7828 dw_die_ref context_die)
7829 {
7830 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
7831 dw_die_ref mod_type_die = NULL;
7832 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
7833 tree item_type = NULL;
7834
7835 if (code != ERROR_MARK)
7836 {
7837 tree qualified_type;
7838
7839 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
7840 this type. */
7841 qualified_type
7842 = get_qualified_type (type,
7843 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
7844 | (is_volatile_type
7845 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
7846
7847 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
7848 if (qualified_type)
7849 {
7850 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
7851 if (mod_type_die)
7852 return mod_type_die;
7853 }
7854
7855 /* Handle C typedef types. */
7856 if (qualified_type && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
7857 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL
7858 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
7859 {
7860 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (qualified_type);
7861 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (type_name);
7862
7863 if (qualified_type == dtype)
7864 {
7865 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
7866 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
7867 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
7868 }
7869 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
7870 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype))
7871 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
7872 type to which it refers. */
7873 mod_type_die
7874 = modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (type_name),
7875 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
7876 context_die);
7877
7878 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
7879 }
7880
7881 if (mod_type_die)
7882 /* OK. */
7883 ;
7884 else if (is_const_type)
7885 {
7886 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7887 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
7888 }
7889 else if (is_volatile_type)
7890 {
7891 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7892 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
7893 }
7894 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
7895 {
7896 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7897 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
7898 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7899 #if 0
7900 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
7901 #endif
7902 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
7903 }
7904 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
7905 {
7906 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7907 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
7908 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7909 #if 0
7910 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
7911 #endif
7912 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
7913 }
7914 else if (is_ada_subrange_type (type))
7915 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type);
7916 else if (is_base_type (type))
7917 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
7918 else
7919 {
7920 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
7921
7922 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
7923 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
7924 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
7925 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
7926 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
7927 ..._TYPE node. */
7928 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
7929 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
7930 else
7931 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
7932 not the main variant. */
7933 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
7934 if (mod_type_die == NULL)
7935 abort ();
7936 }
7937
7938 /* We want to equate the qualified type to the die below. */
7939 type = qualified_type;
7940 }
7941
7942 if (type)
7943 equate_type_number_to_die (type, mod_type_die);
7944 if (item_type)
7945 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
7946 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
7947 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
7948 types are possible in Ada. */
7949 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
7950 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
7951 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
7952 context_die);
7953
7954 if (sub_die != NULL)
7955 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
7956
7957 return mod_type_die;
7958 }
7959
7960 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
7961 an enumerated type. */
7962
7963 static inline int
7964 type_is_enum (tree type)
7965 {
7966 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
7967 }
7968
7969 /* Return the register number described by a given RTL node. */
7970
7971 static unsigned int
7972 reg_number (rtx rtl)
7973 {
7974 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
7975
7976 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7977 abort ();
7978
7979 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
7980 }
7981
7982 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
7983 zero if there is none. */
7984
7985 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7986 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
7987 {
7988 unsigned reg;
7989 rtx regs;
7990
7991 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7992 return 0;
7993
7994 reg = reg_number (rtl);
7995 regs = (*targetm.dwarf_register_span) (rtl);
7996
7997 if (HARD_REGNO_NREGS (reg, GET_MODE (rtl)) > 1
7998 || regs)
7999 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8000 else
8001 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (reg);
8002 }
8003
8004 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8005 a given hard register number. */
8006
8007 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8008 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8009 {
8010 if (regno <= 31)
8011 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8012 else
8013 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8014 }
8015
8016 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8017 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8018
8019 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8020 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8021 {
8022 int nregs, size, i;
8023 unsigned reg;
8024 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8025
8026 reg = reg_number (rtl);
8027 nregs = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (reg, GET_MODE (rtl));
8028
8029 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8030 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8031 {
8032 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8033
8034 loc_result = NULL;
8035 while (nregs--)
8036 {
8037 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8038
8039 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (reg);
8040 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8041 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0));
8042 ++reg;
8043 }
8044 return loc_result;
8045 }
8046
8047 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8048
8049 if (GET_CODE (regs) != PARALLEL)
8050 abort ();
8051
8052 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8053 loc_result = NULL;
8054
8055 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8056 {
8057 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8058
8059 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8060 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8061 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8062 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0));
8063 }
8064 return loc_result;
8065 }
8066
8067 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8068
8069 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8070 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8071 {
8072 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8073
8074 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8075 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8076 if (i >= 0)
8077 {
8078 if (i <= 31)
8079 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8080 else if (i <= 0xff)
8081 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8082 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8083 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8084 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8085 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8086 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8087 else
8088 op = DW_OP_constu;
8089 }
8090 else
8091 {
8092 if (i >= -0x80)
8093 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8094 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8095 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8096 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8097 || i >= -0x80000000)
8098 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8099 else
8100 op = DW_OP_consts;
8101 }
8102
8103 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8104 }
8105
8106 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8107
8108 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8109 based_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, long int offset)
8110 {
8111 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
8112 /* For the "frame base", we use the frame pointer or stack pointer
8113 registers, since the RTL for local variables is relative to one of
8114 them. */
8115 unsigned fp_reg = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (frame_pointer_needed
8116 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8117 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
8118
8119 if (reg == fp_reg)
8120 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8121 else if (reg <= 31)
8122 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + reg, offset, 0);
8123 else
8124 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
8125
8126 return loc_result;
8127 }
8128
8129 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8130
8131 static inline int
8132 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8133 {
8134 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8135 && ((GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == REG
8136 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8137 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8138 }
8139
8140 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8141 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8142 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8143 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8144
8145 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8146 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8147 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8148 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8149
8150 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8151 autoincrement addressing modes.
8152
8153 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8154
8155 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8156 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8157 {
8158 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8159
8160 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8161 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8162 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8163 zeroth element of the array. */
8164
8165 rtl = (*targetm.delegitimize_address) (rtl);
8166
8167 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8168 {
8169 case POST_INC:
8170 case POST_DEC:
8171 case POST_MODIFY:
8172 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8173 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8174
8175 /* ... fall through ... */
8176
8177 case SUBREG:
8178 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8179 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8180 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8181 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8182 contains the given subreg. */
8183 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8184
8185 /* ... fall through ... */
8186
8187 case REG:
8188 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8189 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8190 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8191 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8192 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8193 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8194 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8195 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8196 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8197 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8198 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8199 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8200 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8201 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8202 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (rtl), 0);
8203 break;
8204
8205 case MEM:
8206 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8207 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8208 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8209 break;
8210
8211 case LO_SUM:
8212 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8213
8214 /* ... fall through ... */
8215
8216 case LABEL_REF:
8217 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8218 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8219 pool. */
8220 case CONST:
8221 case SYMBOL_REF:
8222 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8223 by a different symbol. */
8224 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8225 {
8226 bool marked;
8227 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8228
8229 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8230 {
8231 rtl = tmp;
8232 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8233 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8234 else
8235 marked = true;
8236 }
8237
8238 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8239 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8240 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8241 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8242 if (!marked)
8243 return 0;
8244 }
8245
8246 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8247 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8248 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8249 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
8250 break;
8251
8252 case PRE_MODIFY:
8253 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8254 PLUS code below. */
8255 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8256 goto plus;
8257
8258 case PRE_INC:
8259 case PRE_DEC:
8260 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8261 below. */
8262 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8263 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8264 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8265 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8266
8267 /* ... fall through ... */
8268
8269 case PLUS:
8270 plus:
8271 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8272 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
8273 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8274 else
8275 {
8276 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8277 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8278 break;
8279
8280 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8281 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8282 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8283 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8284 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8285 else
8286 {
8287 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8288 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8289 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8290 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8291 }
8292 }
8293 break;
8294
8295 case MULT:
8296 {
8297 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8298 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply. */
8299 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8300 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
8301
8302 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8303 break;
8304
8305 mem_loc_result = op0;
8306 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
8307 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
8308 break;
8309 }
8310
8311 case CONST_INT:
8312 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
8313 break;
8314
8315 case ADDRESSOF:
8316 /* If this is a MEM, return its address. Otherwise, we can't
8317 represent this. */
8318 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == MEM)
8319 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0), mode);
8320 else
8321 return 0;
8322
8323 default:
8324 abort ();
8325 }
8326
8327 return mem_loc_result;
8328 }
8329
8330 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
8331 This is typically a complex variable. */
8332
8333 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8334 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
8335 {
8336 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
8337 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
8338 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
8339
8340 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
8341 return 0;
8342
8343 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
8344 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
8345 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
8346 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)), 0));
8347
8348 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
8349 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
8350 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
8351 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)), 0));
8352
8353 return cc_loc_result;
8354 }
8355
8356 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
8357 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
8358 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
8359 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
8360 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
8361
8362 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
8363
8364 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8365 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8366 {
8367 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8368
8369 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8370 {
8371 case SUBREG:
8372 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8373 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8374 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8375 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8376 contains the given subreg. */
8377 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
8378
8379 /* ... fall through ... */
8380
8381 case REG:
8382 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
8383 break;
8384
8385 case MEM:
8386 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8387 break;
8388
8389 case CONCAT:
8390 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
8391 break;
8392
8393 default:
8394 abort ();
8395 }
8396
8397 return loc_result;
8398 }
8399
8400 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
8401 up particularly with variable length arrays. If ADDRESSP is nonzero, we are
8402 looking for an address. Otherwise, we return a value. If we can't make a
8403 descriptor, return 0. */
8404
8405 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8406 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int addressp)
8407 {
8408 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
8409 int indirect_p = 0;
8410 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
8411 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8412
8413 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
8414 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
8415 problem... */
8416
8417 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
8418 {
8419 case ERROR_MARK:
8420 return 0;
8421
8422 case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
8423 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
8424 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
8425 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
8426 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
8427 the names of types. */
8428 return 0;
8429
8430 case CALL_EXPR:
8431 return 0;
8432
8433 case ADDR_EXPR:
8434 /* We can support this only if we can look through conversions and
8435 find an INDIRECT_EXPR. */
8436 for (loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0);
8437 TREE_CODE (loc) == CONVERT_EXPR || TREE_CODE (loc) == NOP_EXPR
8438 || TREE_CODE (loc) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
8439 || TREE_CODE (loc) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
8440 || TREE_CODE (loc) == SAVE_EXPR;
8441 loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
8442 ;
8443
8444 return (TREE_CODE (loc) == INDIRECT_REF
8445 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp)
8446 : 0);
8447
8448 case VAR_DECL:
8449 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL (loc))
8450 {
8451 rtx rtl;
8452
8453 #ifndef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
8454 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
8455 return 0;
8456 #endif
8457
8458 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
8459 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
8460 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
8461 return 0;
8462
8463 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
8464 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8465 return 0;
8466
8467 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != MEM)
8468 return 0;
8469 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8470 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
8471 return 0;
8472
8473 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
8474 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8475 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8476
8477 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
8478 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
8479
8480 indirect_p = 1;
8481 break;
8482 }
8483 /* FALLTHRU */
8484
8485 case PARM_DECL:
8486 {
8487 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
8488
8489 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8490 return 0;
8491 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
8492 {
8493 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8494 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8495 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8496 indirect_p = 1;
8497 }
8498 else
8499 {
8500 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
8501
8502 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
8503 {
8504 indirect_p = 1;
8505 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8506 }
8507
8508 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
8509 }
8510 }
8511 break;
8512
8513 case INDIRECT_REF:
8514 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8515 indirect_p = 1;
8516 break;
8517
8518 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
8519 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), addressp);
8520
8521 case NOP_EXPR:
8522 case CONVERT_EXPR:
8523 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8524 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
8525 case SAVE_EXPR:
8526 case MODIFY_EXPR:
8527 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp);
8528
8529 case COMPONENT_REF:
8530 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8531 case ARRAY_REF:
8532 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
8533 {
8534 tree obj, offset;
8535 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
8536 enum machine_mode mode;
8537 int volatilep;
8538
8539 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
8540 &unsignedp, &volatilep);
8541
8542 if (obj == loc)
8543 return 0;
8544
8545 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (obj, 1);
8546 if (ret == 0
8547 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
8548 return 0;
8549
8550 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
8551 {
8552 /* Variable offset. */
8553 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree (offset, 0));
8554 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8555 }
8556
8557 if (!addressp)
8558 indirect_p = 1;
8559
8560 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8561 if (bytepos > 0)
8562 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
8563 else if (bytepos < 0)
8564 {
8565 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
8566 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8567 }
8568 break;
8569 }
8570
8571 case INTEGER_CST:
8572 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
8573 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
8574 else
8575 return 0;
8576 break;
8577
8578 case CONSTRUCTOR:
8579 {
8580 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
8581 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
8582 enum machine_mode mode;
8583
8584 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != MEM)
8585 return 0;
8586 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
8587 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8588
8589 rtl = (*targetm.delegitimize_address) (rtl);
8590
8591 indirect_p = 1;
8592 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
8593 break;
8594 }
8595
8596 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
8597 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
8598 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8599 op = DW_OP_and;
8600 goto do_binop;
8601
8602 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
8603 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8604 op = DW_OP_xor;
8605 goto do_binop;
8606
8607 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
8608 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
8609 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8610 op = DW_OP_or;
8611 goto do_binop;
8612
8613 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
8614 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
8615 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
8616 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8617 op = DW_OP_div;
8618 goto do_binop;
8619
8620 case MINUS_EXPR:
8621 op = DW_OP_minus;
8622 goto do_binop;
8623
8624 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
8625 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
8626 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
8627 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8628 op = DW_OP_mod;
8629 goto do_binop;
8630
8631 case MULT_EXPR:
8632 op = DW_OP_mul;
8633 goto do_binop;
8634
8635 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8636 op = DW_OP_shl;
8637 goto do_binop;
8638
8639 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8640 op = (unsignedp ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
8641 goto do_binop;
8642
8643 case PLUS_EXPR:
8644 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8645 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
8646 {
8647 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8648 if (ret == 0)
8649 return 0;
8650
8651 add_loc_descr (&ret,
8652 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8653 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
8654 0),
8655 0));
8656 break;
8657 }
8658
8659 op = DW_OP_plus;
8660 goto do_binop;
8661
8662 case LE_EXPR:
8663 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8664 return 0;
8665
8666 op = DW_OP_le;
8667 goto do_binop;
8668
8669 case GE_EXPR:
8670 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8671 return 0;
8672
8673 op = DW_OP_ge;
8674 goto do_binop;
8675
8676 case LT_EXPR:
8677 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8678 return 0;
8679
8680 op = DW_OP_lt;
8681 goto do_binop;
8682
8683 case GT_EXPR:
8684 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8685 return 0;
8686
8687 op = DW_OP_gt;
8688 goto do_binop;
8689
8690 case EQ_EXPR:
8691 op = DW_OP_eq;
8692 goto do_binop;
8693
8694 case NE_EXPR:
8695 op = DW_OP_ne;
8696 goto do_binop;
8697
8698 do_binop:
8699 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8700 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
8701 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
8702 return 0;
8703
8704 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
8705 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8706 break;
8707
8708 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
8709 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8710 op = DW_OP_not;
8711 goto do_unop;
8712
8713 case ABS_EXPR:
8714 op = DW_OP_abs;
8715 goto do_unop;
8716
8717 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8718 op = DW_OP_neg;
8719 goto do_unop;
8720
8721 do_unop:
8722 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8723 if (ret == 0)
8724 return 0;
8725
8726 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8727 break;
8728
8729 case MAX_EXPR:
8730 loc = build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
8731 build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
8732 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
8733 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
8734
8735 /* ... fall through ... */
8736
8737 case COND_EXPR:
8738 {
8739 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
8740 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
8741 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
8742 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
8743 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
8744
8745 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8746 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
8747 return 0;
8748
8749 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
8750 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
8751
8752 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
8753 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
8754 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
8755
8756 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
8757 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
8758 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
8759
8760 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
8761 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
8762 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
8763 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
8764 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
8765 }
8766 break;
8767
8768 default:
8769 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
8770 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
8771 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
8772 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
8773 return 0;
8774
8775 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
8776 these explicitly. Aborting means we forgot one. */
8777 abort ();
8778 }
8779
8780 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
8781 if (addressp && indirect_p == 0)
8782 return 0;
8783
8784 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
8785 if (!addressp && indirect_p > 0)
8786 {
8787 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
8788
8789 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
8790 return 0;
8791 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8792 op = DW_OP_deref;
8793 else
8794 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
8795
8796 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
8797 }
8798
8799 return ret;
8800 }
8801
8802 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
8803 which is not less than the value itself. */
8804
8805 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
8806 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
8807 {
8808 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
8809 }
8810
8811 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
8812 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
8813 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
8814 ERROR_MARK node. */
8815
8816 static inline tree
8817 field_type (tree decl)
8818 {
8819 tree type;
8820
8821 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8822 return integer_type_node;
8823
8824 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
8825 if (type == NULL_TREE)
8826 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
8827
8828 return type;
8829 }
8830
8831 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
8832 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
8833 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
8834
8835 static inline unsigned
8836 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
8837 {
8838 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
8839 }
8840
8841 static inline unsigned
8842 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
8843 {
8844 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
8845 }
8846
8847 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
8848 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
8849 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
8850 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
8851 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
8852 just yet). */
8853
8854 static HOST_WIDE_INT
8855 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
8856 {
8857 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
8858 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
8859 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
8860 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
8861 tree type;
8862 tree field_size_tree;
8863 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
8864 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
8865 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
8866
8867 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8868 return 0;
8869 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
8870 abort ();
8871
8872 type = field_type (decl);
8873 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
8874
8875 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
8876 a flexible array member. */
8877 if (! field_size_tree)
8878 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
8879
8880 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
8881 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
8882 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
8883 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
8884 return 0;
8885
8886 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
8887
8888 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
8889 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
8890 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
8891 else
8892 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
8893
8894 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
8895 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
8896 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
8897
8898 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
8899 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
8900 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
8901 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
8902 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
8903 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
8904 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
8905 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
8906
8907 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
8908
8909 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
8910 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
8911 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
8912 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
8913 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
8914 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
8915 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
8916 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
8917 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
8918 bits of the bit-field itself.
8919
8920 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
8921 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
8922 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
8923 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
8924 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
8925 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
8926 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
8927 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
8928 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
8929
8930 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
8931 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
8932 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
8933 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
8934 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
8935 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
8936
8937 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
8938 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
8939 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
8940
8941 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
8942 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
8943 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
8944
8945 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
8946 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
8947 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
8948 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
8949
8950 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
8951 {
8952 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
8953 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
8954
8955 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
8956 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
8957 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
8958 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
8959 }
8960
8961 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8962 }
8963 \f
8964 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
8965 associated with them. */
8966
8967 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
8968
8969 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
8970 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
8971 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
8972
8973 static inline void
8974 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
8975 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
8976 {
8977 if (descr != 0)
8978 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
8979 }
8980
8981 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
8982 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
8983 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
8984 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
8985 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
8986 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
8987 function above).
8988
8989 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
8990 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
8991 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
8992 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
8993 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
8994 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
8995 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
8996 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
8997 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
8998 function below.) */
8999
9000 static void
9001 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9002 {
9003 long offset;
9004 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9005
9006 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_VEC)
9007 {
9008 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9009 if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (decl) && is_cxx ())
9010 {
9011 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9012 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9013 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9014 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9015
9016 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9017
9018 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9019
9020 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9021
9022 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9023 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9024 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9025
9026 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9027 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9028 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9029
9030 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9031 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9032 if (offset >= 0)
9033 abort ();
9034
9035 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9036 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9037 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9038 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9039
9040 /* Extract the offset. */
9041 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9042 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9043
9044 /* Add it to the object address. */
9045 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9046 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9047 }
9048 else
9049 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9050 }
9051 else
9052 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9053
9054 if (! loc_descr)
9055 {
9056 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9057
9058 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9059 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9060 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9061
9062 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9063 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9064 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9065 stack. */
9066 op = DW_OP_constu;
9067 #else
9068 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9069 #endif
9070
9071 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9072 }
9073
9074 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9075 }
9076
9077 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9078 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9079 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9080 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9081 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9082
9083 static void
9084 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9085 {
9086 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9087 {
9088 case CONST_INT:
9089 /* Note that a CONST_INT rtx could represent either an integer
9090 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_INT is used whenever
9091 the constant will fit into a single word. In all such
9092 cases, the original mode of the constant value is wiped
9093 out, and the CONST_INT rtx is assigned VOIDmode. */
9094 {
9095 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9096
9097 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9098 if (val < 0 && (long) val == val)
9099 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, (long) val);
9100 else if ((unsigned long) val == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val)
9101 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned long) val);
9102 else
9103 {
9104 #if HOST_BITS_PER_LONG * 2 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9105 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9106 val >> HOST_BITS_PER_LONG, val);
9107 #else
9108 abort ();
9109 #endif
9110 }
9111 }
9112 break;
9113
9114 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9115 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9116 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9117 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9118 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9119 {
9120 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9121
9122 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
9123 {
9124 unsigned length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4;
9125 long *array = ggc_alloc (sizeof (long) * length);
9126 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9127
9128 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9129 real_to_target (array, &rv, mode);
9130
9131 add_AT_float (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, array);
9132 }
9133 else
9134 {
9135 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9136 if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG != HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9137 abort ();
9138
9139 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9140 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9141 }
9142 }
9143 break;
9144
9145 case CONST_STRING:
9146 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
9147 break;
9148
9149 case SYMBOL_REF:
9150 case LABEL_REF:
9151 case CONST:
9152 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
9153 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
9154 break;
9155
9156 case PLUS:
9157 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
9158 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
9159 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
9160 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
9161 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
9162 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
9163 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
9164 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
9165 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
9166 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
9167 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
9168 break;
9169
9170 default:
9171 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
9172 abort ();
9173 }
9174
9175 }
9176
9177 static rtx
9178 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
9179 {
9180 rtx rtl;
9181
9182 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
9183 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
9184 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
9185
9186 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
9187 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
9188 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
9189 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
9190 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
9191 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
9192 referenced within the function.
9193
9194 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
9195 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
9196 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
9197 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
9198
9199 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
9200 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
9201 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
9202 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
9203 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
9204 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
9205
9206 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
9207 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
9208 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
9209 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
9210 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
9211 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
9212 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
9213 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
9214 output at debug-time.
9215
9216 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
9217 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
9218 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
9219 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
9220 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
9221 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
9222 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
9223 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
9224 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
9225 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
9226 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
9227 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
9228 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
9229
9230 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
9231 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
9232 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
9233 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
9234 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
9235 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
9236 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
9237 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
9238 I'd like to fix it.
9239
9240 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
9241 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
9242 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
9243 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
9244 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
9245 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
9246 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
9247 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
9248 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
9249 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
9250 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values, but integrate.c doesn't currently generate these
9251 values for inlined instances of inline function parameters, so when we see
9252 such cases, we are just out-of-luck for the time being (until integrate.c
9253 gets fixed). */
9254
9255 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
9256 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
9257
9258 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
9259 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
9260 fixed registers. */
9261 if (! reload_completed)
9262 {
9263 if (rtl
9264 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
9265 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
9266 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
9267 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == REG
9268 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
9269 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
9270 {
9271 rtl = (*targetm.delegitimize_address) (rtl);
9272 return rtl;
9273 }
9274 rtl = NULL_RTX;
9275 }
9276 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
9277 {
9278 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
9279 {
9280 tree declared_type = type_main_variant (TREE_TYPE (decl));
9281 tree passed_type = type_main_variant (DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl));
9282
9283 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
9284 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
9285 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
9286 if (declared_type == passed_type)
9287 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
9288 else if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9289 && TREE_CODE (declared_type) == INTEGER_TYPE
9290 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (declared_type))
9291 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (passed_type))))
9292 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
9293 }
9294
9295 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
9296 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
9297 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
9298 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
9299 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
9300 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
9301 thing to do. */
9302 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
9303 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
9304 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
9305 /* Not passed in memory. */
9306 && GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)) != MEM
9307 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
9308 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != REG
9309 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
9310 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
9311 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
9312 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
9313 #endif
9314 )
9315 /* Big endian correction check. */
9316 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9317 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
9318 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
9319 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
9320 {
9321 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
9322 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
9323
9324 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
9325 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
9326 }
9327 }
9328
9329 if (rtl != NULL_RTX)
9330 {
9331 rtl = eliminate_regs (rtl, 0, NULL_RTX);
9332 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
9333 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
9334 leaf_renumber_regs_insn (rtl);
9335 #endif
9336 }
9337
9338 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
9339 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
9340 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
9341 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
9342 {
9343 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
9344 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
9345 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == STRING_CST
9346 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9347 {
9348 tree arrtype = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9349 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (arrtype);
9350 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (arrtype);
9351 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
9352 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
9353
9354 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
9355 && domain
9356 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
9357 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
9358 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
9359 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
9360 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
9361 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init));
9362 }
9363 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
9364 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. Expanding anything else
9365 tends to produce unresolved symbols; see debug/5770 and c++/6381. */
9366 else if (TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == INTEGER_CST
9367 || TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (decl)) == REAL_CST)
9368 {
9369 rtl = expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (decl), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
9370 EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
9371 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
9372 if (rtl && GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
9373 abort ();
9374 }
9375 }
9376
9377 if (rtl)
9378 rtl = (*targetm.delegitimize_address) (rtl);
9379
9380 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
9381 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
9382 code, and thus is not emitted. */
9383 if (rtl)
9384 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
9385
9386 return rtl;
9387 }
9388
9389 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
9390 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
9391 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
9392 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
9393 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
9394 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
9395 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
9396 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
9397 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
9398 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
9399
9400 static void
9401 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9402 {
9403 rtx rtl;
9404 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
9405
9406 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9407 return;
9408 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
9409 abort ();
9410
9411 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
9412 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9413 return;
9414
9415 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9416 {
9417 case ADDRESSOF:
9418 /* The address of a variable that was optimized away;
9419 don't emit anything. */
9420 break;
9421
9422 case CONST_INT:
9423 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9424 case CONST_STRING:
9425 case SYMBOL_REF:
9426 case LABEL_REF:
9427 case CONST:
9428 case PLUS:
9429 /* DECL_RTL could be (plus (reg ...) (const_int ...)) */
9430 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
9431 break;
9432
9433 case MEM:
9434 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_THREAD_LOCAL (decl))
9435 {
9436 /* Need loc_descriptor_from_tree since that's where we know
9437 how to handle TLS variables. Want the object's address
9438 since the top-level DW_AT_location assumes such. See
9439 the confusion in loc_descriptor for reference. */
9440 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl, 1);
9441 }
9442 else
9443 {
9444 case REG:
9445 case SUBREG:
9446 case CONCAT:
9447 descr = loc_descriptor (rtl);
9448 }
9449 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, descr);
9450 break;
9451
9452 default:
9453 abort ();
9454 }
9455 }
9456
9457 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
9458 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
9459 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
9460
9461 static void
9462 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
9463 {
9464 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
9465 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9466
9467 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init
9468 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
9469 /* OK */;
9470 else
9471 return;
9472
9473 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
9474 {
9475 case INTEGER_TYPE:
9476 if (host_integerp (init, 0))
9477 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9478 tree_low_cst (init, 0));
9479 else
9480 add_AT_long_long (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9481 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (init),
9482 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (init));
9483 break;
9484
9485 default:;
9486 }
9487 }
9488
9489 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
9490 the value of the attribute. */
9491
9492 static void
9493 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
9494 {
9495 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
9496 {
9497 if (demangle_name_func)
9498 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
9499
9500 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
9501 }
9502 }
9503
9504 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
9505
9506 static void
9507 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
9508 {
9509 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
9510 if (wd != NULL)
9511 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
9512 }
9513
9514 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
9515 a representation for that bound. */
9516
9517 static void
9518 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
9519 {
9520 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
9521 {
9522 case ERROR_MARK:
9523 return;
9524
9525 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
9526 case INTEGER_CST:
9527 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
9528 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
9529 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
9530 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
9531 /* use the default */
9532 ;
9533 else
9534 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
9535 break;
9536
9537 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9538 case NOP_EXPR:
9539 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9540 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9541 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
9542 break;
9543
9544 case SAVE_EXPR:
9545 /* If optimization is turned on, the SAVE_EXPRs that describe how to
9546 access the upper bound values may be bogus. If they refer to a
9547 register, they may only describe how to get at these values at the
9548 points in the generated code right after they have just been
9549 computed. Worse yet, in the typical case, the upper bound values
9550 will not even *be* computed in the optimized code (though the
9551 number of elements will), so these SAVE_EXPRs are entirely
9552 bogus. In order to compensate for this fact, we check here to see
9553 if optimization is enabled, and if so, we don't add an attribute
9554 for the (unknown and unknowable) upper bound. This should not
9555 cause too much trouble for existing (stupid?) debuggers because
9556 they have to deal with empty upper bounds location descriptions
9557 anyway in order to be able to deal with incomplete array types.
9558 Of course an intelligent debugger (GDB?) should be able to
9559 comprehend that a missing upper bound specification in an array
9560 type used for a storage class `auto' local array variable
9561 indicates that the upper bound is both unknown (at compile- time)
9562 and unknowable (at run-time) due to optimization.
9563
9564 We assume that a MEM rtx is safe because gcc wouldn't put the
9565 value there unless it was going to be used repeatedly in the
9566 function, i.e. for cleanups. */
9567 if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)
9568 && (! optimize || GET_CODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)) == MEM))
9569 {
9570 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
9571 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
9572 rtx loc = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound);
9573
9574 /* If the RTL for the SAVE_EXPR is memory, handle the case where
9575 it references an outer function's frame. */
9576 if (GET_CODE (loc) == MEM)
9577 {
9578 rtx new_addr = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (loc, 0), bound);
9579
9580 if (XEXP (loc, 0) != new_addr)
9581 loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (loc), new_addr);
9582 }
9583
9584 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9585 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
9586 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location,
9587 loc_descriptor (loc));
9588 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9589 }
9590
9591 /* Else leave out the attribute. */
9592 break;
9593
9594 case VAR_DECL:
9595 case PARM_DECL:
9596 {
9597 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
9598
9599 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
9600 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
9601 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
9602 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
9603 later parameter. */
9604 if (decl_die != NULL)
9605 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9606 break;
9607 }
9608
9609 default:
9610 {
9611 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
9612 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
9613
9614 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
9615 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
9616
9617 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound, 0);
9618 if (loc == NULL)
9619 break;
9620
9621 if (current_function_decl == 0)
9622 ctx = comp_unit_die;
9623 else
9624 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
9625
9626 /* If we weren't able to find a context, it's most likely the case
9627 that we are processing the return type of the function. So
9628 make a SAVE_EXPR to point to it and have the limbo DIE code
9629 find the proper die. The save_expr function doesn't always
9630 make a SAVE_EXPR, so do it ourselves. */
9631 if (ctx == 0)
9632 bound = build (SAVE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (bound), bound,
9633 current_function_decl, NULL_TREE);
9634
9635 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
9636 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9637 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
9638 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
9639
9640 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9641 break;
9642 }
9643 }
9644 }
9645
9646 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
9647 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
9648
9649 static void
9650 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
9651 {
9652 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9653 unsigned dimension_number;
9654 #endif
9655 tree lower, upper;
9656 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
9657
9658 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
9659 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
9660 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
9661 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
9662 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
9663 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
9664 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
9665 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
9666
9667 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
9668 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
9669 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
9670 gen_array_type_die. */
9671 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9672 for (dimension_number = 0;
9673 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
9674 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
9675 #endif
9676 {
9677 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9678
9679 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
9680 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
9681 here. */
9682 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
9683 if (domain)
9684 {
9685 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
9686 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
9687 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
9688
9689 /* Define the index type. */
9690 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
9691 {
9692 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
9693 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
9694 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
9695 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
9696 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
9697 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
9698 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
9699 ;
9700 else
9701 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
9702 type_die);
9703 }
9704
9705 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
9706 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
9707 dimension arr(N:*)
9708 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
9709 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
9710 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
9711
9712 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
9713 if (upper)
9714 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
9715 }
9716
9717 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
9718 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
9719 bounds. */
9720 }
9721 }
9722
9723 static void
9724 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
9725 {
9726 unsigned size;
9727
9728 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
9729 {
9730 case ERROR_MARK:
9731 size = 0;
9732 break;
9733 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
9734 case RECORD_TYPE:
9735 case UNION_TYPE:
9736 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
9737 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
9738 break;
9739 case FIELD_DECL:
9740 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
9741 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
9742 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
9743 even for bit-fields. */
9744 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9745 break;
9746 default:
9747 abort ();
9748 }
9749
9750 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
9751 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
9752 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
9753 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
9754 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
9755 }
9756
9757 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
9758 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
9759 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
9760 bit-field itself.
9761
9762 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9763 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9764 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9765 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
9766 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
9767 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
9768
9769 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
9770 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
9771 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
9772
9773 static inline void
9774 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9775 {
9776 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
9777 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9778 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9779 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
9780 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
9781 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
9782
9783 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
9784 if (!type
9785 || TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
9786 abort ();
9787
9788 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
9789 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
9790 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
9791 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
9792 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
9793 return;
9794
9795 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9796
9797 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
9798 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
9799 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
9800 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
9801 below must take account of these differences. */
9802 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
9803 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
9804
9805 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
9806 {
9807 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
9808 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9809 }
9810
9811 bit_offset
9812 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9813 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
9814 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
9815
9816 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
9817 }
9818
9819 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
9820 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
9821
9822 static inline void
9823 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9824 {
9825 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
9826 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL
9827 || ! DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
9828 abort ();
9829
9830 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
9831 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
9832 }
9833
9834 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
9835 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
9836
9837 static inline void
9838 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
9839 {
9840 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
9841 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
9842 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
9843 }
9844
9845 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
9846 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
9847 equate table. */
9848
9849 static inline void
9850 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
9851 {
9852 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
9853
9854 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
9855 {
9856 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
9857 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
9858 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
9859
9860 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
9861 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
9862 tree fn = origin;
9863
9864 if (TYPE_P (fn))
9865 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
9866
9867 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
9868 if (fn)
9869 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
9870 }
9871
9872 if (DECL_P (origin))
9873 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
9874 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
9875 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
9876
9877 if (origin_die == NULL)
9878 abort ();
9879
9880 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
9881 }
9882
9883 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
9884
9885 static inline void
9886 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
9887 {
9888 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
9889 {
9890 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
9891
9892 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
9893 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
9894 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
9895 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
9896 0));
9897
9898 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
9899 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
9900 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
9901 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
9902 }
9903 }
9904 \f
9905 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
9906
9907 static void
9908 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9909 {
9910 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
9911
9912 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
9913 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
9914 }
9915
9916 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
9917 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
9918
9919 static void
9920 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9921 {
9922 tree decl_name;
9923
9924 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
9925 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
9926 {
9927 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
9928 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
9929 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
9930
9931 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
9932 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
9933 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
9934 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
9935 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
9936 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
9937 }
9938
9939 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9940 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
9941 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
9942 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
9943 {
9944 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
9945 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
9946 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
9947 }
9948 #endif
9949 }
9950
9951 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
9952
9953 static void
9954 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
9955 {
9956 VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (decl_scope_table, scope);
9957 }
9958
9959 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
9960
9961 static inline void
9962 pop_decl_scope (void)
9963 {
9964 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) <= 0)
9965 abort ();
9966
9967 VARRAY_POP (decl_scope_table);
9968 }
9969
9970 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
9971 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
9972 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
9973 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
9974 the current active scope. */
9975
9976 static dw_die_ref
9977 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
9978 {
9979 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
9980 tree containing_scope;
9981 int i;
9982
9983 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
9984 if (! TYPE_P (t))
9985 abort ();
9986
9987 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
9988
9989 /* Ignore namespaces for the moment. */
9990 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
9991 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
9992
9993 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
9994 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
9995 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
9996 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
9997 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
9998
9999 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
10000 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10001 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
10002 {
10003 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
10004 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
10005 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
10006 for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
10007 if (VARRAY_TREE (decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
10008 break;
10009
10010 if (i < 0)
10011 {
10012 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
10013 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope))
10014 abort ();
10015
10016 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
10017 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
10018 }
10019 else
10020 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
10021 }
10022 else
10023 scope_die = context_die;
10024
10025 return scope_die;
10026 }
10027
10028 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
10029
10030 static inline int
10031 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10032 {
10033 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
10034 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
10035 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10036 return 1;
10037
10038 return 0;
10039 }
10040
10041 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
10042
10043 static inline int
10044 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
10045 {
10046 return (context_die
10047 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10048 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
10049 }
10050
10051 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
10052 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
10053 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
10054
10055 static void
10056 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
10057 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
10058 {
10059 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
10060 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
10061
10062 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
10063 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
10064 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
10065 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
10066 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
10067 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
10068 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
10069
10070 if (code == ERROR_MARK
10071 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
10072 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
10073 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
10074 || code == VOID_TYPE)
10075 return;
10076
10077 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
10078 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
10079 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
10080 context_die);
10081
10082 if (type_die != NULL)
10083 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
10084 }
10085
10086 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
10087 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
10088 was declared without a tag. */
10089
10090 static const char *
10091 type_tag (tree type)
10092 {
10093 const char *name = 0;
10094
10095 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
10096 {
10097 tree t = 0;
10098
10099 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
10100 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
10101 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
10102
10103 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
10104 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
10105 involved. */
10106 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
10107 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
10108 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
10109
10110 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
10111 if (t != 0)
10112 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
10113 }
10114
10115 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
10116 }
10117
10118 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
10119 for bit field types. */
10120
10121 static inline tree
10122 member_declared_type (tree member)
10123 {
10124 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
10125 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
10126 }
10127
10128 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
10129 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
10130
10131 #if 0
10132 static const char *
10133 decl_start_label (tree decl)
10134 {
10135 rtx x;
10136 const char *fnname;
10137
10138 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
10139 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
10140 abort ();
10141
10142 x = XEXP (x, 0);
10143 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
10144 abort ();
10145
10146 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
10147 return fnname;
10148 }
10149 #endif
10150 \f
10151 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
10152 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
10153 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
10154
10155 static void
10156 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10157 {
10158 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
10159 dw_die_ref array_die;
10160 tree element_type;
10161
10162 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
10163 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
10164 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
10165 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10166 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
10167 #endif
10168
10169 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
10170 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
10171 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
10172
10173 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10174 {
10175 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
10176 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
10177 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
10178 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
10179 }
10180
10181 #if 0
10182 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
10183 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
10184 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
10185 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
10186 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
10187 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
10188 for multidimensional arrays. */
10189 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
10190 #endif
10191
10192 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10193 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
10194 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
10195 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
10196 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10197 else
10198 #endif
10199 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
10200
10201 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
10202 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10203
10204 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10205 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10206 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10207 add_subscript_info. */
10208 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10209 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10210 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
10211
10212 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
10213 #endif
10214
10215 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
10216 }
10217
10218 static void
10219 gen_set_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10220 {
10221 dw_die_ref type_die
10222 = new_die (DW_TAG_set_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10223
10224 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
10225 add_type_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10226 }
10227
10228 #if 0
10229 static void
10230 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
10231 {
10232 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10233 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
10234
10235 if (origin != NULL)
10236 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
10237 else
10238 {
10239 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
10240 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10241 0, 0, context_die);
10242 }
10243
10244 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10245 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
10246 else
10247 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
10248 }
10249 #endif
10250
10251 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
10252 emit full debugging info for them. */
10253
10254 static void
10255 retry_incomplete_types (void)
10256 {
10257 int i;
10258
10259 for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
10260 gen_type_die (VARRAY_TREE (incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
10261 }
10262
10263 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
10264
10265 static void
10266 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10267 {
10268 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
10269
10270 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
10271 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
10272 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
10273 }
10274
10275 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
10276
10277 static void
10278 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10279 {
10280 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
10281
10282 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
10283 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
10284 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
10285 }
10286
10287 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
10288
10289 static void
10290 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10291 {
10292 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
10293
10294 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
10295 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
10296 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
10297 }
10298
10299 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
10300 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
10301 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
10302 DIE. */
10303
10304 static void
10305 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10306 {
10307 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
10308
10309 if (type_die == NULL)
10310 {
10311 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
10312 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10313 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
10314 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
10315 }
10316 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
10317 return;
10318 else
10319 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
10320
10321 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
10322 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
10323 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
10324 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
10325 {
10326 tree link;
10327
10328 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
10329 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
10330 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
10331 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
10332
10333 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
10334 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
10335 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
10336 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
10337
10338 for (link = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
10339 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
10340 {
10341 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
10342
10343 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
10344 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
10345
10346 if (host_integerp (TREE_VALUE (link),
10347 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (link)))))
10348 {
10349 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (TREE_VALUE (link)) < 0)
10350 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
10351 tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 0));
10352 else
10353 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
10354 tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 1));
10355 }
10356 }
10357 }
10358 else
10359 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10360 }
10361
10362 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
10363 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
10364 type.
10365
10366 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
10367 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
10368 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
10369 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
10370 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
10371 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
10372 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
10373 argument type of some subprogram type. */
10374
10375 static dw_die_ref
10376 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
10377 {
10378 dw_die_ref parm_die
10379 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
10380 tree origin;
10381
10382 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
10383 {
10384 case 'd':
10385 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
10386 if (origin != NULL)
10387 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
10388 else
10389 {
10390 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
10391 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
10392 TREE_READONLY (node),
10393 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
10394 context_die);
10395 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
10396 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10397 }
10398
10399 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
10400 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
10401 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node);
10402
10403 break;
10404
10405 case 't':
10406 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
10407 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
10408 break;
10409
10410 default:
10411 abort ();
10412 }
10413
10414 return parm_die;
10415 }
10416
10417 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
10418 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
10419
10420 static void
10421 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10422 {
10423 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
10424 }
10425
10426 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
10427 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
10428 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
10429 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
10430
10431 static void
10432 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
10433 {
10434 tree link;
10435 tree formal_type = NULL;
10436 tree first_parm_type;
10437 tree arg;
10438
10439 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
10440 {
10441 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
10442 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
10443 }
10444 else
10445 arg = NULL_TREE;
10446
10447 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
10448
10449 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
10450 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
10451 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
10452 {
10453 dw_die_ref parm_die;
10454
10455 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
10456 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
10457 break;
10458
10459 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
10460 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
10461 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
10462 && link == first_parm_type)
10463 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
10464 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10465
10466 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
10467 if (arg)
10468 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
10469 }
10470
10471 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
10472 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
10473 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
10474 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
10475
10476 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
10477 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
10478 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
10479 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
10480 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
10481 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
10482 }
10483
10484 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
10485 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
10486 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
10487 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
10488 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
10489
10490 static void
10491 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
10492 {
10493 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
10494
10495 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
10496 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
10497 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
10498 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
10499 {
10500 if (decl_ultimate_origin (member))
10501 abort ();
10502
10503 push_decl_scope (type);
10504 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
10505 gen_subprogram_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
10506 else
10507 gen_variable_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
10508
10509 pop_decl_scope ();
10510 }
10511 }
10512
10513 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
10514 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
10515
10516 static void
10517 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
10518 {
10519 dw_die_ref old_die;
10520 tree save_fn;
10521 tree context;
10522 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
10523
10524 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
10525 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
10526
10527 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10528 if (old_die && get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10529 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
10530 return;
10531
10532 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
10533 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
10534 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10535 {
10536 context = decl_class_context (decl);
10537 if (context)
10538 gen_type_die_for_member
10539 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
10540 }
10541
10542 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
10543 save_fn = current_function_decl;
10544 current_function_decl = decl;
10545
10546 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
10547 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
10548 if (! was_abstract)
10549 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
10550
10551 current_function_decl = save_fn;
10552 }
10553
10554 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
10555 block-local). */
10556
10557 static void
10558 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
10559 {
10560 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10561 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10562 dw_die_ref subr_die;
10563 rtx fp_reg;
10564 tree fn_arg_types;
10565 tree outer_scope;
10566 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10567 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
10568 || class_scope_p (context_die));
10569
10570 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
10571 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
10572 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
10573 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
10574 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
10575
10576 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
10577 if (origin && declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
10578 {
10579 origin = NULL;
10580 if (old_die)
10581 abort ();
10582 }
10583
10584 if (origin != NULL)
10585 {
10586 if (declaration && ! local_scope_p (context_die))
10587 abort ();
10588
10589 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
10590 inline function. */
10591 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
10592 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
10593
10594 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10595 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
10596 }
10597 else if (old_die)
10598 {
10599 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
10600
10601 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
10602 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
10603 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
10604 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
10605 && !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10606 {
10607 /* ??? This can happen if there is a bug in the program, for
10608 instance, if it has duplicate function definitions. Ideally,
10609 we should detect this case and ignore it. For now, if we have
10610 already reported an error, any error at all, then assume that
10611 we got here because of an input error, not a dwarf2 bug. */
10612 if (errorcount)
10613 return;
10614 abort ();
10615 }
10616
10617 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
10618 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
10619 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
10620 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
10621 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
10622 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
10623 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
10624 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
10625 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
10626 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
10627 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10628 == (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl)))))
10629 {
10630 subr_die = old_die;
10631
10632 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the parm types. */
10633 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
10634 remove_children (subr_die);
10635 }
10636 else
10637 {
10638 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10639 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10640 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
10641 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10642 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10643 != (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
10644 add_AT_unsigned
10645 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
10646 }
10647 }
10648 else
10649 {
10650 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10651
10652 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10653 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
10654
10655 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
10656 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10657 {
10658 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
10659 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10660 0, 0, context_die);
10661 }
10662
10663 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
10664 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10665 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10666
10667 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10668 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10669 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10670 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10671 }
10672
10673 if (declaration)
10674 {
10675 if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10676 {
10677 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10678
10679 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
10680 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
10681 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
10682 handled above. The two may come from the same source text. */
10683 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10684 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10685 }
10686 }
10687 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10688 {
10689 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
10690 {
10691 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
10692 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
10693 else
10694 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
10695 }
10696 else
10697 {
10698 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
10699 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
10700 else
10701 abort ();
10702 }
10703
10704 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10705 }
10706 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
10707 {
10708 if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10709 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10710
10711 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
10712 current_function_funcdef_no);
10713 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
10714 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10715 current_function_funcdef_no);
10716 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
10717
10718 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
10719 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
10720
10721 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10722 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
10723 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
10724 #endif
10725
10726 /* Define the "frame base" location for this routine. We use the
10727 frame pointer or stack pointer registers, since the RTL for local
10728 variables is relative to one of them. */
10729 fp_reg
10730 = frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx : stack_pointer_rtx;
10731 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, reg_loc_descriptor (fp_reg));
10732
10733 #if 0
10734 /* ??? This fails for nested inline functions, because context_display
10735 is not part of the state saved/restored for inline functions. */
10736 if (current_function_needs_context)
10737 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
10738 loc_descriptor (lookup_static_chain (decl)));
10739 #endif
10740 }
10741
10742 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
10743 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
10744 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
10745 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
10746 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
10747 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
10748 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
10749 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
10750 an ellipsis at the end. */
10751
10752 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
10753 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
10754 its formal parameters. */
10755 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10756 ;
10757 else if (declaration)
10758 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
10759 else
10760 {
10761 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
10762 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
10763 tree parm;
10764
10765 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
10766 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
10767 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
10768 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
10769 {
10770 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
10771 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
10772 "__builtin_va_alist"))
10773 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
10774 else
10775 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
10776 }
10777
10778 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
10779 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
10780 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
10781 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
10782 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
10783 parameters at all. */
10784 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
10785 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
10786 {
10787 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
10788 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
10789 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
10790 }
10791 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
10792 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
10793 }
10794
10795 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
10796 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
10797 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10798
10799 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
10800 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
10801 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
10802 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
10803 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
10804 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
10805 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
10806
10807 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
10808 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
10809 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
10810 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
10811 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
10812 constructor function. */
10813 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
10814 {
10815 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
10816 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
10817
10818 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10819 if (current_function_has_inlines)
10820 {
10821 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
10822 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
10823 {
10824 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
10825 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
10826 }
10827 }
10828 #endif
10829 }
10830 }
10831
10832 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
10833
10834 static void
10835 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
10836 {
10837 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10838 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
10839
10840 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10841 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
10842 || class_scope_p (context_die));
10843
10844 if (origin != NULL)
10845 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
10846
10847 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
10848 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
10849
10850 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
10851 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
10852 sharing them.
10853
10854 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
10855 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl)
10856 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
10857 {
10858 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
10859 add_AT_die_ref (var_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10860 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
10861 {
10862 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
10863
10864 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
10865 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10866
10867 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10868 != (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
10869
10870 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line,
10871 DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
10872 }
10873 }
10874 else
10875 {
10876 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
10877 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
10878 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
10879
10880 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10881 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
10882
10883 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10884 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10885
10886 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10887 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10888 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10889 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10890 }
10891
10892 if (declaration)
10893 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10894
10895 if (class_scope_p (context_die) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10896 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
10897
10898 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10899 {
10900 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
10901 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
10902 }
10903 else
10904 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
10905 }
10906
10907 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
10908
10909 static void
10910 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
10911 {
10912 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10913 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
10914 rtx insn;
10915 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10916
10917 if (origin != NULL)
10918 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
10919 else
10920 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
10921
10922 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10923 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
10924 else
10925 {
10926 insn = DECL_RTL (decl);
10927
10928 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
10929 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
10930 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
10931 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL
10932 || ((GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE
10933 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL)))
10934 {
10935 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
10936 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
10937 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
10938 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
10939 it if it ever does happen. */
10940 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
10941 abort ();
10942
10943 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
10944 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10945 }
10946 }
10947 }
10948
10949 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
10950
10951 static void
10952 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
10953 {
10954 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
10955 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10956
10957 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
10958 {
10959 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
10960 {
10961 tree chain;
10962
10963 add_AT_range_list (stmt_die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
10964
10965 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
10966 do
10967 {
10968 add_ranges (chain);
10969 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
10970 }
10971 while (chain);
10972 add_ranges (NULL);
10973 }
10974 else
10975 {
10976 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
10977 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10978 add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10979 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
10980 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10981 add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
10982 }
10983 }
10984
10985 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
10986 }
10987
10988 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
10989
10990 static void
10991 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
10992 {
10993 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
10994
10995 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
10996 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
10997 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
10998 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
10999 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
11000
11001 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
11002 {
11003 dw_die_ref subr_die
11004 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
11005 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11006
11007 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11008 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
11009 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
11010 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
11011 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
11012 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
11013 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
11014 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
11015 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
11016 }
11017 else
11018 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
11019 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
11020 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
11021 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
11022 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
11023 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
11024 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
11025 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
11026 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
11027 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
11028 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
11029 intended :-) */
11030 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11031 }
11032
11033 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
11034
11035 static void
11036 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11037 {
11038 dw_die_ref decl_die;
11039
11040 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
11041 return;
11042
11043 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
11044 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11045 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
11046 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
11047 context_die);
11048
11049 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
11050 {
11051 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11052 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11053 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11054 }
11055
11056 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
11057 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
11058
11059 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11060 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11061
11062 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11063 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11064 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11065 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11066 }
11067
11068 #if 0
11069 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
11070 Use modified_type_die instead.
11071 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
11072 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
11073
11074 static void
11075 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11076 {
11077 dw_die_ref ptr_die
11078 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11079
11080 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
11081 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
11082 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
11083 }
11084
11085 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
11086 Use modified_type_die instead.
11087 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
11088 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
11089
11090 static void
11091 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11092 {
11093 dw_die_ref ref_die
11094 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11095
11096 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
11097 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
11098 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
11099 }
11100 #endif
11101
11102 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
11103
11104 static void
11105 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11106 {
11107 dw_die_ref ptr_die
11108 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
11109 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11110
11111 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
11112 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11113 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
11114 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
11115 }
11116
11117 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
11118
11119 static dw_die_ref
11120 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
11121 {
11122 dw_die_ref die;
11123 char producer[250];
11124 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
11125 int language;
11126
11127 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
11128
11129 if (filename)
11130 {
11131 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
11132 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
11133 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
11134 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
11135 }
11136
11137 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
11138
11139 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11140 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
11141 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
11142 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
11143 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
11144 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
11145 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
11146 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11147 strcat (producer, " -g");
11148 #endif
11149
11150 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
11151
11152 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
11153 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
11154 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
11155 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
11156 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
11157 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
11158 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
11159 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
11160 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
11161 language = DW_LANG_Java;
11162 else
11163 language = DW_LANG_C89;
11164
11165 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
11166 return die;
11167 }
11168
11169 /* Generate a DIE for a string type. */
11170
11171 static void
11172 gen_string_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11173 {
11174 dw_die_ref type_die
11175 = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11176
11177 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11178
11179 /* ??? Fudge the string length attribute for now.
11180 TODO: add string length info. */
11181 #if 0
11182 string_length_attribute (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
11183 bound_representation (upper_bound, 0, 'u');
11184 #endif
11185 }
11186
11187 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
11188
11189 static void
11190 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
11191 {
11192 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
11193
11194 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
11195 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
11196
11197 if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (binfo))
11198 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
11199
11200 if (access == access_public_node)
11201 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
11202 else if (access == access_protected_node)
11203 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11204 }
11205
11206 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
11207
11208 static void
11209 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11210 {
11211 tree member;
11212 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
11213 dw_die_ref child;
11214
11215 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
11216 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
11217 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
11218 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
11219 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
11220 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
11221 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
11222 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
11223 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
11224 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
11225 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
11226
11227 /* First output info about the base classes. */
11228 if (binfo && BINFO_BASETYPES (binfo))
11229 {
11230 tree bases = BINFO_BASETYPES (binfo);
11231 tree accesses = BINFO_BASEACCESSES (binfo);
11232 int n_bases = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (bases);
11233 int i;
11234
11235 for (i = 0; i < n_bases; i++)
11236 gen_inheritance_die (TREE_VEC_ELT (bases, i),
11237 (accesses ? TREE_VEC_ELT (accesses, i)
11238 : access_public_node), context_die);
11239 }
11240
11241 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
11242 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
11243 {
11244 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
11245 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
11246 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
11247 do put them in the right order. */
11248
11249 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
11250 if (child)
11251 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
11252 else
11253 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
11254 }
11255
11256 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
11257 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
11258 {
11259 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
11260 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
11261 continue;
11262
11263 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
11264 if (child)
11265 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
11266 else
11267 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
11268 }
11269 }
11270
11271 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
11272 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
11273 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
11274
11275 static void
11276 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11277 {
11278 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11279 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
11280 int nested = 0;
11281 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
11282 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
11283 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
11284
11285 if (type_die && ! complete)
11286 return;
11287
11288 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
11289 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
11290 nested = 1;
11291
11292 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11293
11294 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
11295 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
11296 {
11297 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
11298
11299 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
11300 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
11301 scope_die, type);
11302 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11303 if (old_die)
11304 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
11305 else
11306 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11307 }
11308 else
11309 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11310
11311 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
11312 then give a list of members. */
11313 if (complete)
11314 {
11315 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
11316 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
11317 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11318 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11319 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11320 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11321
11322 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11323 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11324 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11325 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
11326
11327 push_decl_scope (type);
11328 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
11329 pop_decl_scope ();
11330
11331 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
11332 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
11333 {
11334 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
11335
11336 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
11337 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11338 lookup_type_die (vtype));
11339 }
11340 }
11341 else
11342 {
11343 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11344
11345 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
11346 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
11347 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
11348 VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (incomplete_types, type);
11349 }
11350 }
11351
11352 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
11353
11354 static void
11355 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11356 {
11357 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11358 dw_die_ref subr_die
11359 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
11360 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11361
11362 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
11363 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
11364 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11365 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
11366 }
11367
11368 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
11369
11370 static void
11371 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11372 {
11373 dw_die_ref type_die;
11374 tree origin;
11375
11376 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11377 return;
11378
11379 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
11380 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
11381 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11382 if (origin != NULL)
11383 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
11384 else
11385 {
11386 tree type;
11387
11388 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
11389 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
11390 {
11391 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
11392
11393 if (type == TREE_TYPE (decl))
11394 abort ();
11395 else
11396 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
11397 }
11398 else
11399 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
11400
11401 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
11402 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
11403 }
11404
11405 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11406 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
11407 }
11408
11409 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
11410
11411 static void
11412 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11413 {
11414 int need_pop;
11415
11416 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
11417 return;
11418
11419 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11420 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11421 {
11422 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
11423 return;
11424
11425 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
11426 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == type)
11427 abort ();
11428
11429 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11430 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
11431 return;
11432 }
11433
11434 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
11435 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
11436 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
11437 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
11438 cloned type itself). */
11439 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
11440 type = type_main_variant (type);
11441
11442 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
11443 return;
11444
11445 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11446 {
11447 case ERROR_MARK:
11448 break;
11449
11450 case POINTER_TYPE:
11451 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
11452 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
11453 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
11454 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
11455 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
11456 statement. */
11457 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11458
11459 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
11460 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
11461 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11462 break;
11463
11464 case OFFSET_TYPE:
11465 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
11466 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
11467 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
11468
11469 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
11470 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11471
11472 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
11473 itself. */
11474 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
11475 break;
11476
11477 case SET_TYPE:
11478 gen_type_die (TYPE_DOMAIN (type), context_die);
11479 gen_set_type_die (type, context_die);
11480 break;
11481
11482 case FILE_TYPE:
11483 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11484 abort (); /* No way to represent these in Dwarf yet! */
11485 break;
11486
11487 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
11488 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
11489 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11490 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
11491 break;
11492
11493 case METHOD_TYPE:
11494 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
11495 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11496 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
11497 break;
11498
11499 case ARRAY_TYPE:
11500 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == CHAR_TYPE)
11501 {
11502 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11503 gen_string_type_die (type, context_die);
11504 }
11505 else
11506 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
11507 break;
11508
11509 case VECTOR_TYPE:
11510 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
11511 break;
11512
11513 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11514 case RECORD_TYPE:
11515 case UNION_TYPE:
11516 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11517 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
11518 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
11519 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
11520 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
11521 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
11522 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
11523 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
11524 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
11525 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
11526 {
11527 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
11528
11529 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
11530 return;
11531
11532 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
11533 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
11534 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
11535 need_pop = 1;
11536 }
11537 else
11538 need_pop = 0;
11539
11540 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
11541 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
11542 else
11543 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
11544
11545 if (need_pop)
11546 pop_decl_scope ();
11547
11548 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
11549 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
11550 when appropriate. */
11551 return;
11552
11553 case VOID_TYPE:
11554 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11555 case REAL_TYPE:
11556 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
11557 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
11558 case CHAR_TYPE:
11559 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
11560 break;
11561
11562 case LANG_TYPE:
11563 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
11564 break;
11565
11566 default:
11567 abort ();
11568 }
11569
11570 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11571 }
11572
11573 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
11574
11575 static void
11576 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11577 {
11578 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
11579 return;
11580
11581 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
11582 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
11583 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
11584 type now. */
11585 if (type != type_main_variant (type))
11586 abort ();
11587
11588 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
11589 an instance of an unresolved type. */
11590
11591 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11592 {
11593 case ERROR_MARK:
11594 break;
11595
11596 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11597 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
11598 break;
11599
11600 case RECORD_TYPE:
11601 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
11602 break;
11603
11604 case UNION_TYPE:
11605 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11606 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
11607 break;
11608
11609 default:
11610 abort ();
11611 }
11612 }
11613
11614 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
11615 things which are local to the given block. */
11616
11617 static void
11618 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
11619 {
11620 int must_output_die = 0;
11621 tree origin;
11622 tree decl;
11623 enum tree_code origin_code;
11624
11625 /* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
11626 if (stmt == NULL_TREE || !TREE_USED (stmt)
11627 || (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt) && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)))
11628 return;
11629
11630 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
11631 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
11632 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
11633 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
11634 {
11635 tree sub;
11636
11637 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
11638 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
11639
11640 return;
11641 }
11642
11643 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
11644 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
11645 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
11646 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
11647 the current block. */
11648 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
11649 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
11650
11651 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
11652 block. */
11653 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
11654 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
11655 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
11656 must_output_die = 1;
11657 else
11658 {
11659 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
11660 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
11661 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
11662 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
11663 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
11664 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
11665 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
11666 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
11667 {
11668 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
11669 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
11670 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11671 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
11672 as being a "significant" one. */
11673 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL);
11674 else
11675 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
11676 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
11677 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
11678 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11679 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
11680 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
11681 {
11682 must_output_die = 1;
11683 break;
11684 }
11685 }
11686 }
11687
11688 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
11689 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
11690 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
11691 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
11692 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
11693 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
11694 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
11695 if (must_output_die)
11696 {
11697 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
11698 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11699 else
11700 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11701 }
11702 else
11703 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
11704 }
11705
11706 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
11707 all of its sub-blocks. */
11708
11709 static void
11710 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
11711 {
11712 tree decl;
11713 tree subblocks;
11714
11715 /* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
11716 if (stmt == NULL_TREE || ! TREE_USED (stmt))
11717 return;
11718
11719 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
11720 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
11721 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
11722 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
11723 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11724 {
11725 dw_die_ref die;
11726
11727 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11728 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11729 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
11730 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11731 else
11732 die = NULL;
11733
11734 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
11735 add_child_die (context_die, die);
11736 else
11737 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
11738 }
11739
11740 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
11741 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11742 return;
11743
11744 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
11745 therein) of this block. */
11746 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
11747 subblocks != NULL;
11748 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
11749 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
11750 }
11751
11752 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
11753
11754 static inline int
11755 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
11756 {
11757 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
11758 return 1;
11759
11760 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11761 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
11762 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11763 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
11764 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
11765 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
11766 return 1;
11767
11768 return 0;
11769 }
11770
11771 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
11772
11773 static void
11774 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11775 {
11776 tree origin;
11777
11778 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
11779 return;
11780
11781 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
11782 {
11783 case ERROR_MARK:
11784 break;
11785
11786 case CONST_DECL:
11787 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
11788 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
11789 break;
11790
11791 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11792 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
11793 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
11794 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
11795 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
11796 break;
11797
11798 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
11799 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
11800 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
11801
11802 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
11803 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
11804 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
11805 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11806 && ! class_scope_p (context_die)
11807 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
11808 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
11809 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
11810 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11811 {
11812 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
11813 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
11814 }
11815
11816 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
11817 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11818 {
11819 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
11820 have described its return type. */
11821 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
11822
11823 /* And its virtual context. */
11824 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11825 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
11826
11827 /* And its containing type. */
11828 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
11829 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
11830 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
11831 }
11832
11833 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
11834 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
11835 break;
11836
11837 case TYPE_DECL:
11838 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11839 actual typedefs. */
11840 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11841 break;
11842
11843 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
11844 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
11845 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
11846 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
11847 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
11848 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
11849 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11850 {
11851 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11852 break;
11853 }
11854
11855 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
11856 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11857 else
11858 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
11859 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
11860 break;
11861
11862 case LABEL_DECL:
11863 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
11864 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
11865 break;
11866
11867 case VAR_DECL:
11868 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11869 variable declarations or definitions. */
11870 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11871 break;
11872
11873 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
11874 object. */
11875 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11876
11877 /* And its containing type. */
11878 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
11879 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
11880 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
11881
11882 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
11883 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
11884 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
11885 function. */
11886 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11887 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
11888 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
11889 else
11890 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
11891 break;
11892
11893 case FIELD_DECL:
11894 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
11895 anonymous unions. */
11896 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
11897 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE)
11898 {
11899 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
11900 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
11901 }
11902 break;
11903
11904 case PARM_DECL:
11905 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11906 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
11907 break;
11908
11909 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
11910 /* Ignore for now. */
11911 break;
11912
11913 default:
11914 if ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES)
11915 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
11916 break;
11917 abort ();
11918 }
11919 }
11920 \f
11921 /* Add Ada "use" clause information for SGI Workshop debugger. */
11922
11923 void
11924 dwarf2out_add_library_unit_info (const char *filename, const char *context_list)
11925 {
11926 unsigned int file_index;
11927
11928 if (filename != NULL)
11929 {
11930 dw_die_ref unit_die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11931 tree context_list_decl
11932 = build_decl (LABEL_DECL, get_identifier (context_list),
11933 void_type_node);
11934
11935 TREE_PUBLIC (context_list_decl) = TRUE;
11936 add_name_attribute (unit_die, context_list);
11937 file_index = lookup_filename (filename);
11938 add_AT_unsigned (unit_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11939 add_pubname (context_list_decl, unit_die);
11940 }
11941 }
11942
11943 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
11944 compilation proper has finished. */
11945
11946 static void
11947 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
11948 {
11949 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
11950 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
11951 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
11952 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
11953 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
11954 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11955 }
11956
11957 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
11958
11959 void
11960 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
11961 {
11962 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
11963
11964 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
11965 {
11966 case ERROR_MARK:
11967 return;
11968
11969 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11970 /* Ignore this FUNCTION_DECL if it refers to a builtin declaration of a
11971 builtin function. Explicit programmer-supplied declarations of
11972 these same functions should NOT be ignored however. */
11973 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && DECL_BUILT_IN (decl))
11974 return;
11975
11976 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
11977 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
11978 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
11979 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
11980 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
11981 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
11982 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
11983 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
11984 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
11985 with the definition of the function.
11986
11987 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
11988 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
11989 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
11990 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
11991 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
11992 translation unit (an thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
11993 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
11994 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
11995 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
11996 that they *are* definitions).
11997
11998 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
11999 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
12000 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
12001 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
12002 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
12003 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
12004 return;
12005
12006 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
12007 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
12008 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
12009 if (decl_function_context (decl)
12010 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
12011 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12012 context_die = NULL;
12013 break;
12014
12015 case VAR_DECL:
12016 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
12017 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
12018 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
12019 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
12020 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
12021 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
12022 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
12023 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
12024 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
12025 return;
12026
12027 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
12028 variable declarations or definitions. */
12029 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12030 return;
12031 break;
12032
12033 case TYPE_DECL:
12034 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
12035 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
12036 return;
12037
12038 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
12039 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
12040 if (DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl) == 0)
12041 {
12042 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
12043 comparisons have. */
12044 if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
12045 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
12046 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
12047 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
12048 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
12049
12050 return;
12051 }
12052
12053 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
12054 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12055 return;
12056
12057 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
12058 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
12059 if (decl_function_context (decl))
12060 context_die = NULL;
12061
12062 break;
12063
12064 default:
12065 return;
12066 }
12067
12068 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12069 }
12070
12071 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
12072 a lexical block. */
12073
12074 static void
12075 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12076 unsigned int blocknum)
12077 {
12078 function_section (current_function_decl);
12079 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
12080 }
12081
12082 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
12083 lexical block. */
12084
12085 static void
12086 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
12087 {
12088 function_section (current_function_decl);
12089 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
12090 }
12091
12092 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
12093 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
12094
12095 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
12096 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
12097 we may end up calling them anyway. */
12098
12099 static bool
12100 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
12101 {
12102 tree decl;
12103
12104 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12105 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12106 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
12107 return 0;
12108
12109 return 1;
12110 }
12111
12112 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
12113 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
12114 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
12115 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
12116 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
12117 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
12118 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
12119 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
12120 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
12121 all searches. */
12122
12123 static unsigned
12124 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
12125 {
12126 size_t i, n;
12127 char *save_file_name;
12128
12129 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
12130 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
12131 if (file_table_last_lookup_index != 0)
12132 {
12133 const char *last
12134 = VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, file_table_last_lookup_index);
12135 if (strcmp (file_name, last) == 0)
12136 return file_table_last_lookup_index;
12137 }
12138
12139 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table */
12140 n = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table);
12141 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
12142 if (strcmp (file_name, VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)) == 0)
12143 {
12144 file_table_last_lookup_index = i;
12145 return i;
12146 }
12147
12148 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
12149 file_table_last_lookup_index = n;
12150 save_file_name = (char *) ggc_strdup (file_name);
12151 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, save_file_name);
12152 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
12153
12154 return i;
12155 }
12156
12157 static int
12158 maybe_emit_file (int fileno)
12159 {
12160 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO && fileno > 0)
12161 {
12162 if (!VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno))
12163 {
12164 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno) = ++emitcount;
12165 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ",
12166 VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno));
12167 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
12168 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, fileno));
12169 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
12170 }
12171 return VARRAY_UINT (file_table_emitted, fileno);
12172 }
12173 else
12174 return fileno;
12175 }
12176
12177 static void
12178 init_file_table (void)
12179 {
12180 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
12181 VARRAY_CHAR_PTR_INIT (file_table, 64, "file_table");
12182 VARRAY_UINT_INIT (file_table_emitted, 64, "file_table_emitted");
12183
12184 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
12185 VARRAY_PUSH_CHAR_PTR (file_table, NULL);
12186 VARRAY_PUSH_UINT (file_table_emitted, 0);
12187 file_table_last_lookup_index = 0;
12188 }
12189
12190 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
12191 and record information relating to this source line, in
12192 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
12193
12194 static void
12195 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
12196 {
12197 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
12198 && line != 0)
12199 {
12200 function_section (current_function_decl);
12201
12202 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
12203 if (flag_debug_asm)
12204 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
12205 filename, line);
12206
12207 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
12208 {
12209 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
12210
12211 file_num = maybe_emit_file (file_num);
12212
12213 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
12214 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
12215
12216 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
12217 line_info_table_in_use++;
12218
12219 /* Indicate that multiple line number tables exist. */
12220 if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
12221 separate_line_info_table_in_use++;
12222 }
12223 else if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
12224 {
12225 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
12226 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
12227 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
12228
12229 /* expand the line info table if necessary */
12230 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
12231 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
12232 {
12233 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12234 separate_line_info_table
12235 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
12236 separate_line_info_table_allocated
12237 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
12238 memset (separate_line_info_table
12239 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
12240 0,
12241 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
12242 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
12243 }
12244
12245 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
12246 line_info
12247 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
12248 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
12249 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
12250 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
12251 }
12252 else
12253 {
12254 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
12255
12256 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
12257 line_info_table_in_use);
12258
12259 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
12260 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
12261 {
12262 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12263 line_info_table
12264 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
12265 (line_info_table_allocated
12266 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
12267 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
12268 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
12269 }
12270
12271 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
12272 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
12273 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
12274 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
12275 }
12276 }
12277 }
12278
12279 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
12280
12281 static void
12282 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
12283 {
12284 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
12285 {
12286 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
12287 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
12288
12289 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
12290 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
12291 }
12292
12293 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12294 {
12295 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12296 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
12297 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
12298 lineno);
12299 maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
12300 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lookup_filename (filename),
12301 "Filename we just started");
12302 }
12303 }
12304
12305 /* Record the end of a source file. */
12306
12307 static void
12308 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12309 {
12310 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
12311 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
12312 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
12313
12314 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12315 {
12316 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12317 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
12318 }
12319 }
12320
12321 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
12322 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
12323 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
12324
12325 static void
12326 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12327 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12328 {
12329 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12330 {
12331 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12332 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
12333 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
12334 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
12335 }
12336 }
12337
12338 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
12339 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
12340 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
12341
12342 static void
12343 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12344 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12345 {
12346 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12347 {
12348 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12349 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
12350 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
12351 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
12352 }
12353 }
12354
12355 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
12356
12357 static void
12358 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12359 {
12360 init_file_table ();
12361
12362 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_die_table. */
12363 decl_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
12364 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
12365 decl_die_table_allocated = DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12366 decl_die_table_in_use = 0;
12367
12368 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
12369 VARRAY_TREE_INIT (decl_scope_table, 256, "decl_scope_table");
12370
12371 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
12372 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
12373 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
12374 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12375 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
12376 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
12377
12378 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
12379 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
12380 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
12381 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12382
12383 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
12384 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
12385
12386 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
12387 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
12388 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
12389 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
12390 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
12391 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
12392 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
12393
12394 VARRAY_TREE_INIT (incomplete_types, 64, "incomplete_types");
12395
12396 VARRAY_RTX_INIT (used_rtx_varray, 32, "used_rtx_varray");
12397
12398 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
12399 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
12400 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12401 if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
12402 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12403 else
12404 strcpy (text_section_label, stripattributes (TEXT_SECTION_NAME));
12405
12406 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
12407 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12408 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
12409 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12410 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
12411 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12412 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12413 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
12414 named_section_flags (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12415 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
12416 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12417 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
12418
12419 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12420 {
12421 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12422 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
12423 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12424 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
12425 }
12426
12427 if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
12428 {
12429 text_section ();
12430 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
12431 }
12432 }
12433
12434 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
12435 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
12436
12437 static int
12438 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12439 {
12440 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
12441
12442 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
12443 {
12444 named_section_flags (DEBUG_STR_SECTION, DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS);
12445 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
12446 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
12447 }
12448
12449 return 1;
12450 }
12451
12452
12453
12454 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
12455 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
12456
12457 static void
12458 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
12459 {
12460 dw_die_ref c;
12461 die->die_mark = 0;
12462 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
12463 prune_unmark_dies (c);
12464 }
12465
12466
12467 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
12468 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
12469
12470 static void
12471 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
12472 {
12473 dw_attr_ref a;
12474
12475 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
12476 {
12477 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
12478 {
12479 /* A reference to another DIE.
12480 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
12481 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
12482 }
12483 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file)
12484 {
12485 /* A reference to a file. Make sure the file name is emitted. */
12486 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned =
12487 maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
12488 }
12489 }
12490 }
12491
12492
12493 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
12494 to DIE's children. */
12495
12496 static void
12497 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
12498 {
12499 dw_die_ref c;
12500
12501 if (die->die_mark == 0)
12502 {
12503 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
12504 die->die_mark = 1;
12505
12506 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
12507 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
12508 if (die->die_parent)
12509 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
12510
12511 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
12512 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
12513 }
12514
12515 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
12516 {
12517 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
12518 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
12519 die->die_mark = 2;
12520
12521 /* Walk them. */
12522 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
12523 {
12524 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
12525 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
12526 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
12527 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
12528 else
12529 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
12530 }
12531 }
12532 }
12533
12534
12535 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
12536
12537 static void
12538 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
12539 {
12540 dw_die_ref c;
12541
12542 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
12543 if (die->die_mark)
12544 return;
12545
12546 switch (die->die_tag) {
12547 case DW_TAG_const_type:
12548 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
12549 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
12550 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
12551 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
12552 case DW_TAG_typedef:
12553 case DW_TAG_array_type:
12554 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
12555 case DW_TAG_union_type:
12556 case DW_TAG_class_type:
12557 case DW_TAG_friend:
12558 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
12559 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
12560 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
12561 case DW_TAG_string_type:
12562 case DW_TAG_set_type:
12563 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
12564 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
12565 case DW_TAG_file_type:
12566 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
12567 return;
12568
12569 default:
12570 /* Mark everything else. */
12571 break;
12572 }
12573
12574 die->die_mark = 1;
12575
12576 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
12577 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
12578
12579 /* Mark children. */
12580 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
12581 prune_unused_types_walk (c);
12582 }
12583
12584
12585 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
12586
12587 static void
12588 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
12589 {
12590 dw_die_ref c, p, n;
12591 if (!die->die_mark)
12592 abort();
12593
12594 p = NULL;
12595 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = n)
12596 {
12597 n = c->die_sib;
12598 if (c->die_mark)
12599 {
12600 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
12601 p = c;
12602 }
12603 else
12604 {
12605 if (p)
12606 p->die_sib = n;
12607 else
12608 die->die_child = n;
12609 free_die (c);
12610 }
12611 }
12612 }
12613
12614
12615 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
12616
12617 static void
12618 prune_unused_types (void)
12619 {
12620 unsigned int i;
12621 limbo_die_node *node;
12622
12623 /* Clear all the marks. */
12624 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
12625 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12626 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
12627
12628 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
12629 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
12630 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12631 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
12632
12633 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
12634 pubname_table or arange_table. */
12635 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
12636 prune_unused_types_mark (pubname_table[i].die, 1);
12637 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
12638 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
12639
12640 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked. */
12641 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
12642 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12643 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
12644
12645 /* Leave the marks clear. */
12646 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
12647 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12648 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
12649 }
12650
12651 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
12652 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
12653
12654 static void
12655 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
12656 {
12657 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
12658 dw_die_ref die = 0;
12659
12660 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
12661 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
12662 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
12663 if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
12664 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
12665 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
12666 {
12667 size_t i;
12668 for (i = 1; i < VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (file_table); i++)
12669 if (VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR
12670 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
12671 && VARRAY_CHAR_PTR (file_table, i)[0] != '<')
12672 {
12673 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
12674 break;
12675 }
12676 }
12677
12678 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
12679 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
12680 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
12681 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
12682 instance. */
12683 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
12684 {
12685 next_node = node->next;
12686 die = node->die;
12687
12688 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
12689 {
12690 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
12691 tree context;
12692
12693 if (origin)
12694 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
12695 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
12696 ;
12697 /* If this was an expression for a bound involved in a function
12698 return type, it may be a SAVE_EXPR for which we weren't able
12699 to find a DIE previously. So try now. */
12700 else if (node->created_for
12701 && TREE_CODE (node->created_for) == SAVE_EXPR
12702 && 0 != (origin = (lookup_decl_die
12703 (SAVE_EXPR_CONTEXT
12704 (node->created_for)))))
12705 add_child_die (origin, die);
12706 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
12707 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
12708 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
12709 else if (node->created_for
12710 && ((DECL_P (node->created_for)
12711 && (context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for)))
12712 || (TYPE_P (node->created_for)
12713 && (context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for))))
12714 && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12715 {
12716 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
12717 nested function can be optimized away, which results
12718 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
12719 with the return type of that nested function. Force
12720 this to be a child of the containing function. */
12721 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
12722 if (! origin)
12723 abort ();
12724 add_child_die (origin, die);
12725 }
12726 else
12727 abort ();
12728 }
12729 }
12730
12731 limbo_die_list = NULL;
12732
12733 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
12734 emit full debugging info for them. */
12735 retry_incomplete_types ();
12736
12737 /* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
12738 we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
12739 reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
12740
12741 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
12742 prune_unused_types ();
12743
12744 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
12745 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
12746 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
12747 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
12748
12749 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
12750 that have children. */
12751 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
12752 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12753 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
12754
12755 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
12756 text_section ();
12757 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
12758
12759 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
12760 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
12761 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
12762 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
12763 examining the file. */
12764 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
12765 {
12766 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12767 output_line_info ();
12768 }
12769
12770 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
12771 if (have_location_lists)
12772 {
12773 /* Output the location lists info. */
12774 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12775 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
12776 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12777 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
12778 output_location_lists (die);
12779 have_location_lists = 0;
12780 }
12781
12782 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
12783 in .text. */
12784 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
12785 {
12786 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
12787 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
12788 }
12789
12790 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
12791 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
12792 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
12793 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
12794
12795 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
12796 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
12797 debug_line_section_label);
12798
12799 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12800 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
12801
12802 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
12803 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
12804 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12805 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
12806
12807 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
12808
12809 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
12810 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12811 output_abbrev_section ();
12812
12813 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
12814 if (pubname_table_in_use)
12815 {
12816 named_section_flags (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12817 output_pubnames ();
12818 }
12819
12820 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
12821 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
12822 if (fde_table_in_use)
12823 {
12824 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12825 output_aranges ();
12826 }
12827
12828 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
12829 if (ranges_table_in_use)
12830 {
12831 named_section_flags (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12832 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
12833 output_ranges ();
12834 }
12835
12836 /* Have to end the primary source file. */
12837 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12838 {
12839 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12840 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
12841 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
12842 }
12843
12844 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
12845 table too. */
12846 if (debug_str_hash)
12847 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
12848 }
12849 #else
12850
12851 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
12852 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
12853
12854 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12855
12856 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"